perlapi - autogenerated documentation for the perl public API
This file contains the documentation of the perl public API generated by embed.pl, specifically a listing of functions, macros, flags, and variables that may be used by extension writers. At the end is a list of functions which have yet to be documented. The interfaces of those are subject to change without notice. Anything not listed here is not part of the public API, and should not be used by extension writers at all. For these reasons, blindly using functions listed in proto.h is to be avoided when writing extensions.
In Perl, unlike C, a string of characters may generally contain embedded NUL
characters. Sometimes in the documentation a Perl string is referred to as a "buffer" to distinguish it from a C string, but sometimes they are both just referred to as strings.
Note that all Perl API global variables must be referenced with the PL_
prefix. Again, those not listed here are not to be used by extension writers, and can be changed or removed without notice; same with macros. Some macros are provided for compatibility with the older, unadorned names, but this support may be disabled in a future release.
Perl was originally written to handle US-ASCII only (that is characters whose ordinal numbers are in the range 0 - 127). And documentation and comments may still use the term ASCII, when sometimes in fact the entire range from 0 - 255 is meant.
The non-ASCII characters below 256 can have various meanings, depending on various things. (See, most notably, perllocale.) But usually the whole range can be referred to as ISO-8859-1. Often, the term "Latin-1" (or "Latin1") is used as an equivalent for ISO-8859-1. But some people treat "Latin1" as referring just to the characters in the range 128 through 255, or somethimes from 160 through 255. This documentation uses "Latin1" and "Latin-1" to refer to all 256 characters.
Note that Perl can be compiled and run under either ASCII or EBCDIC (See perlebcdic). Most of the documentation (and even comments in the code) ignore the EBCDIC possibility. For almost all purposes the differences are transparent. As an example, under EBCDIC, instead of UTF-8, UTF-EBCDIC is used to encode Unicode strings, and so whenever this documentation refers to utf8
(and variants of that name, including in function names), it also (essentially transparently) means UTF-EBCDIC
. But the ordinals of characters differ between ASCII, EBCDIC, and the UTF- encodings, and a string encoded in UTF-EBCDIC may occupy a different number of bytes than in UTF-8.
The listing below is alphabetical, case insensitive.
Frees the all the elements of an array, leaving it empty. The XS equivalent of @array = ()
. See also "av_undef".
Does not free the memory av
uses to store its list of scalars. If any destructors are triggered as a result, av
itself may be freed when this function returns.
Note that it is possible that the actions of a destructor called directly or indirectly by freeing an element of the array could cause the reference count of the array itself to be reduced (e.g. by deleting an entry in the symbol table). So it is a possibility that the AV could have been freed (or even reallocated) on return from the call unless you hold a reference to it.
void av_clear(AV *av)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Push an SV onto the end of the array, creating the array if necessary. A small internal helper function to remove a commonly duplicated idiom.
void av_create_and_push(AV **const avp,
SV *const val)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Unshifts an SV onto the beginning of the array, creating the array if necessary. A small internal helper function to remove a commonly duplicated idiom.
SV** av_create_and_unshift_one(AV **const avp,
SV *const val)
Deletes the element indexed by key
from the array, makes the element mortal, and returns it. If flags
equals G_DISCARD
, the element is freed and NULL is returned. NULL is also returned if key
is out of range.
Perl equivalent: splice(@myarray, $key, 1, undef)
(with the splice
in void context if G_DISCARD
is present).
SV* av_delete(AV *av, SSize_t key, I32 flags)
Returns true if the element indexed by key
has been initialized.
This relies on the fact that uninitialized array elements are set to NULL
.
Perl equivalent: exists($myarray[$key])
.
bool av_exists(AV *av, SSize_t key)
Pre-extend an array. The key
is the index to which the array should be extended.
void av_extend(AV *av, SSize_t key)
Returns the SV at the specified index in the array. The key
is the index. If lval is true, you are guaranteed to get a real SV back (in case it wasn't real before), which you can then modify. Check that the return value is non-null before dereferencing it to a SV*
.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied arrays.
The rough perl equivalent is $myarray[$key]
.
SV** av_fetch(AV *av, SSize_t key, I32 lval)
Same as av_top_index()
or av_tindex()
.
SSize_t AvFILL(AV* av)
Set the highest index in the array to the given number, equivalent to Perl's $#array = $fill;
.
The number of elements in the array will be fill + 1
after av_fill()
returns. If the array was previously shorter, then the additional elements appended are set to NULL. If the array was longer, then the excess elements are freed. av_fill(av, -1)
is the same as av_clear(av)
.
void av_fill(AV *av, SSize_t fill)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Populates the shaped array with empty default values, where the values depend on the optional type declaration. undef for none, 0 for int and uint, 0.0 for num, "" for str. The type can empty, native like int, uint, str, num, or a coretype like Int, UInt, Str, Num.
Perl equivalent: my @a[5]; my int @b[5]; my Int @c[5];
AV* av_init_shaped(AV *av, const SSize_t size,
const HV *type)
Same as "av_top_index". Note that, unlike what the name implies, it returns the highest index in the array, so to get the size of the array you need to use av_len(av) + 1
. This is unlike "sv_len", which returns what you would expect.
SSize_t av_len(AV *av)
Creates a new AV and populates it with a list of SVs. The SVs are copied into the array, so they may be freed after the call to av_make
. The new AV will have a reference count of 1.
Perl equivalent: my @new_array = ($scalar1, $scalar2, $scalar3...);
AV* av_make(SSize_t size, SV **strp)
Removes one SV from the end of the array, reducing its size by one and returning the SV (transferring control of one reference count) to the caller. Returns UNDEF
if the array is empty.
Perl equivalent: pop(@myarray);
SV* av_pop(AV *av)
Pushes an SV (transferring control of one reference count) onto the end of the array. The array will grow automatically to accommodate the addition.
Perl equivalent: push @myarray, $val;
.
void av_push(AV *av, SV *val)
Removes one SV from the start of the array, reducing its size by one and returning the SV (transferring control of one reference count) to the caller. Returns UNDEF
if the array is empty.
Perl equivalent: shift(@myarray);
SV* av_shift(AV *av)
Stores an SV in an array. The array index is specified as key
. The return value will be NULL
if the operation failed or if the value did not need to be actually stored within the array (as in the case of tied arrays). Otherwise, it can be dereferenced to get the SV*
that was stored there (= val
)).
Note that the caller is responsible for suitably incrementing the reference count of val
before the call, and decrementing it if the function returned NULL
.
Approximate Perl equivalent: $myarray[$key] = $val
or better splice(@myarray, $key, 1, $val)
. It is not exactly like $myarray[$key] = $val
, since it replaces the stored SV with a different SV, rather than just updating the current SV's value.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied arrays.
SV** av_store(AV *av, SSize_t key, SV *val)
Possibly optimizes the internal representation of an array if typed or sparse. For now does nothing. NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void av_study(AV *av)
Same as av_top_index()
.
SSize_t av_tindex(AV* av)
Returns the highest index in the array. The number of elements in the array is av_top_index(av) + 1
. Returns -1 if the array is empty.
The Perl equivalent for this is $#myarray
.
(A slightly shorter form is av_tindex
.)
SSize_t av_top_index(AV *av)
Undefines the array. The XS equivalent of undef(@array)
.
As well as freeing all the elements of the array (like av_clear()
), this also frees the memory used by the av to store its list of scalars.
If any destructors are triggered as a result, av
itself may be freed.
See "av_clear" for a note about the array possibly being invalid on return.
void av_undef(AV *av)
Unshift the given number of undef
values onto the beginning of the array. The array will grow automatically to accommodate the addition.
Perl equivalent: unshift @myarray, ((undef) x $num);
void av_unshift(AV *av, SSize_t num)
Uses strlen
to get the length of name
, then calls get_avn_flags
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
AV* get_av(const char *name, I32 flags)
Returns the AV of the specified Perl global or package array with the given name (so it won't work on lexical variables). flags
are passed to gv_fetchpv
. If GV_ADD
is set and the Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If flags
is zero and the variable does not exist then NULL is returned.
Perl equivalent: @{"$name"}
.
In cperl only.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
AV* get_avn_flags(const char* name, STRLEN len,
I32 flags)
get_avs("Name", flags)
to be used with a constant string.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
AV* get_avs(const char *name, I32 flags)
Creates a new AV. The reference count is set to 1.
Perl equivalent: my @array;
.
AV* newAV()
In-place sort an array of SV pointers with the given comparison routine.
Currently this always uses mergesort. See "sortsv_flags"
for a more flexible routine.
void sortsv(SV** array, size_t num_elts,
SVCOMPARE_t cmp)
In-place sort an array of SV pointers with the given comparison routine, with various SORTf_* flag options.
void sortsv_flags(SV** array, size_t num_elts,
SVCOMPARE_t cmp, U32 flags)
Performs a callback to the specified named and package-scoped Perl subroutine with argv
(a NULL
-terminated array of strings) as arguments. See perlcall.
Approximate Perl equivalent: &{"$sub_name"}(@$argv)
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_argv(const char* sub_name, I32 flags,
char** argv)
Performs a callback to the specified Perl method. The blessed object must be on the stack. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_method(const char* methname, I32 flags)
Performs a callback to the specified Perl sub. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_pv(const char* sub_name, I32 flags)
Performs a callback to the Perl sub specified by the SV.
If neither the G_METHOD
nor G_METHOD_NAMED
flag is supplied, the SV may be any of a CV, a GV, a reference to a CV, a reference to a GV or SvPV(sv)
will be used as the name of the sub to call.
If the G_METHOD
flag is supplied, the SV may be a reference to a CV or SvPV(sv)
will be used as the name of the method to call.
If the G_METHOD_NAMED
flag is supplied, SvPV(sv)
will be used as the name of the method to call.
Some other values are treated specially for internal use and should not be depended on.
See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 call_sv(SV* sv, volatile I32 flags)
Opening bracket on a callback. See "LEAVE"
and perlcall.
ENTER;
Same as "ENTER"
, but when debugging is enabled it also associates the given literal string with the new scope.
ENTER_with_name(name);
Tells Perl to eval
the given string in scalar context and return an SV* result.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* eval_pv(const char* p, I32 croak_on_error)
Tells Perl to eval
the string in the SV. It supports the same flags as call_sv
, with the obvious exception of G_EVAL
. See perlcall.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
I32 eval_sv(SV* sv, I32 flags)
Closing bracket for temporaries on a callback. See "SAVETMPS"
and perlcall.
FREETMPS;
Closing bracket on a callback. See "ENTER"
and perlcall.
LEAVE;
Same as "LEAVE"
, but when debugging is enabled it first checks that the scope has the given name. name
must be a literal string.
LEAVE_with_name(name);
Opening bracket for temporaries on a callback. See "FREETMPS"
and perlcall.
SAVETMPS;
Perl uses "full" Unicode case mappings. This means that converting a single character to another case may result in a sequence of more than one character. For example, the uppercase of ß
(LATIN SMALL LETTER SHARP S) is the two character sequence SS
. This presents some complications The lowercase of all characters in the range 0..255 is a single character, and thus "toLOWER_L1"
is furnished. But, toUPPER_L1
can't exist, as it couldn't return a valid result for all legal inputs. Instead "toUPPER_uvchr"
has an API that does allow every possible legal result to be returned.) Likewise no other function that is crippled by not being able to give the correct results for the full range of possible inputs has been implemented here.
Converts the specified character to foldcase. If the input is anything but an ASCII uppercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant toFOLD_A
is equivalent. (There is no equivalent to_FOLD_L1
for the full Latin1 range, as the full generality of "toFOLD_uvchr" is needed there.)
U8 toFOLD(U8 ch)
This is like "toFOLD_utf8_safe"
, but doesn't have the e
parameter The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take the e
parameter, becoming a synonym for toFOLD_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to toFOLD_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use toFOLD_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
UV toFOLD_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the first UTF-8 encoded character in the sequence starting at p
and extending no further than e - 1
to its foldcase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the foldcase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the foldcased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
UV toFOLD_utf8_safe(U8* p, U8* e, U8* s,
STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the code point cp
to its foldcase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. The code point is interpreted as native if less than 256; otherwise as Unicode. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the foldcase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the foldcased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
UV toFOLD_uvchr(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the specified character to lowercase. If the input is anything but an ASCII uppercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant toLOWER_A
is equivalent.
U8 toLOWER(U8 ch)
Converts the specified Latin1 character to lowercase. The results are undefined if the input doesn't fit in a byte.
U8 toLOWER_L1(U8 ch)
Converts the specified character to lowercase using the current locale's rules, if possible; otherwise returns the input character itself.
U8 toLOWER_LC(U8 ch)
This is like "toLOWER_utf8_safe"
, but doesn't have the e
parameter The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take the e
parameter, becoming a synonym for toLOWER_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to toLOWER_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use toLOWER_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
UV toLOWER_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the first UTF-8 encoded character in the sequence starting at p
and extending no further than e - 1
to its lowercase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the lowercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the lowercased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
UV toLOWER_utf8_safe(U8* p, U8* e, U8* s,
STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the code point cp
to its lowercase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. The code point is interpreted as native if less than 256; otherwise as Unicode. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the lowercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the lowercased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
UV toLOWER_uvchr(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the specified character to titlecase. If the input is anything but an ASCII lowercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant toTITLE_A
is equivalent. (There is no toTITLE_L1
for the full Latin1 range, as the full generality of "toTITLE_uvchr" is needed there. Titlecase is not a concept used in locale handling, so there is no functionality for that.)
U8 toTITLE(U8 ch)
This is like "toLOWER_utf8_safe"
, but doesn't have the e
parameter The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take the e
parameter, becoming a synonym for toTITLE_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to toTITLE_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use toTITLE_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
UV toTITLE_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the first UTF-8 encoded character in the sequence starting at p
and extending no further than e - 1
to its titlecase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the titlecase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the titlecased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
UV toTITLE_utf8_safe(U8* p, U8* e, U8* s,
STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the code point cp
to its titlecase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. The code point is interpreted as native if less than 256; otherwise as Unicode. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the titlecase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the titlecased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
UV toTITLE_uvchr(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the specified character to uppercase. If the input is anything but an ASCII lowercase character, that input character itself is returned. Variant toUPPER_A
is equivalent.
U8 toUPPER(U8 ch)
This is like "toUPPER_utf8_safe"
, but doesn't have the e
parameter The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take the e
parameter, becoming a synonym for toUPPER_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to toUPPER_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use toUPPER_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
UV toUPPER_utf8(U8* p, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the first UTF-8 encoded character in the sequence starting at p
and extending no further than e - 1
to its uppercase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the uppercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the uppercased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more).
The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
UV toUPPER_utf8_safe(U8* p, U8* e, U8* s,
STRLEN* lenp)
Converts the code point cp
to its uppercase version, and stores that in UTF-8 in s
, and its length in bytes in lenp
. The code point is interpreted as native if less than 256; otherwise as Unicode. Note that the buffer pointed to by s
needs to be at least UTF8_MAXBYTES_CASE+1
bytes since the uppercase version may be longer than the original character.
The first code point of the uppercased version is returned (but note, as explained at the top of this section, that there may be more.)
UV toUPPER_uvchr(UV cp, U8* s, STRLEN* lenp)
This section is about functions (really macros) that classify characters into types, such as punctuation versus alphabetic, etc. Most of these are analogous to regular expression character classes. (See "POSIX Character Classes" in perlrecharclass.) There are several variants for each class. (Not all macros have all variants; each item below lists the ones valid for it.) None are affected by use bytes
, and only the ones with LC
in the name are affected by the current locale.
The base function, e.g., isALPHA()
, takes an octet (either a char
or a U8
) as input and returns a boolean as to whether or not the character represented by that octet is (or on non-ASCII platforms, corresponds to) an ASCII character in the named class based on platform, Unicode, and Perl rules. If the input is a number that doesn't fit in an octet, FALSE is returned.
Variant isFOO_A
(e.g., isALPHA_A()
) is identical to the base function with no suffix "_A"
. This variant is used to emphasize by its name that only ASCII-range characters can return TRUE.
Variant isFOO_L1
imposes the Latin-1 (or EBCDIC equivalent) character set onto the platform. That is, the code points that are ASCII are unaffected, since ASCII is a subset of Latin-1. But the non-ASCII code points are treated as if they are Latin-1 characters. For example, isWORDCHAR_L1()
will return true when called with the code point 0xDF, which is a word character in both ASCII and EBCDIC (though it represents different characters in each).
Variant isFOO_uvchr
is like the isFOO_L1
variant, but accepts any UV code point as input. If the code point is larger than 255, Unicode rules are used to determine if it is in the character class. For example, isWORDCHAR_uvchr(0x100)
returns TRUE, since 0x100 is LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH MACRON in Unicode, and is a word character.
Variant isFOO_utf8_safe
is like isFOO_uvchr
, but is used for UTF-8 encoded strings. Each call classifies one character, even if the string contains many. This variant takes two parameters. The first, p
, is a pointer to the first byte of the character to be classified. (Recall that it may take more than one byte to represent a character in UTF-8 strings.) The second parameter, e
, points to anywhere in the string beyond the first character, up to one byte past the end of the entire string. The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return FALSE, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
Variant isFOO_utf8
is like isFOO_utf8_safe
, but takes just a single parameter, p
, which has the same meaning as the corresponding parameter does in isFOO_utf8_safe
. The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take a second parameter, becoming a synonym for isFOO_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to isFOO_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use isFOO_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
Variant isFOO_LC
is like the isFOO_A
and isFOO_L1
variants, but the result is based on the current locale, which is what LC
in the name stands for. If Perl can determine that the current locale is a UTF-8 locale, it uses the published Unicode rules; otherwise, it uses the C library function that gives the named classification. For example, isDIGIT_LC()
when not in a UTF-8 locale returns the result of calling isdigit()
. FALSE is always returned if the input won't fit into an octet. On some platforms where the C library function is known to be defective, Perl changes its result to follow the POSIX standard's rules.
Variant isFOO_LC_uvchr
is like isFOO_LC
, but is defined on any UV. It returns the same as isFOO_LC
for input code points less than 256, and returns the hard-coded, not-affected-by-locale, Unicode results for larger ones.
Variant isFOO_LC_utf8_safe
is like isFOO_LC_uvchr
, but is used for UTF-8 encoded strings. Each call classifies one character, even if the string contains many. This variant takes two parameters. The first, p
, is a pointer to the first byte of the character to be classified. (Recall that it may take more than one byte to represent a character in UTF-8 strings.) The second parameter, e
, points to anywhere in the string beyond the first character, up to one byte past the end of the entire string. The suffix _safe
in the function's name indicates that it will not attempt to read beyond e - 1
, provided that the constraint s < e
is true (this is asserted for in -DDEBUGGING
builds). If the UTF-8 for the input character is malformed in some way, the program may croak, or the function may return FALSE, at the discretion of the implementation, and subject to change in future releases.
Variant isFOO_LC_utf8
is like isFOO_LC_utf8_safe
, but takes just a single parameter, p
, which has the same meaning as the corresponding parameter does in isFOO_LC_utf8_safe
. The function therefore can't check if it is reading beyond the end of the string. Starting in Perl v5.30, it will take a second parameter, becoming a synonym for isFOO_LC_utf8_safe
. At that time every program that uses it will have to be changed to successfully compile. In the meantime, the first runtime call to isFOO_LC_utf8
from each call point in the program will raise a deprecation warning, enabled by default. You can convert your program now to use isFOO_LC_utf8_safe
, and avoid the warnings, and get an extra measure of protection, or you can wait until v5.30, when you'll be forced to add the e
parameter.
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an alphabetic character, analogous to m/[[:alpha:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isALPHA_A
, isALPHA_L1
, isALPHA_uvchr
, isALPHA_utf8_safe
, isALPHA_LC
, isALPHA_LC_uvchr
, and isALPHA_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isALPHA(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a either an alphabetic character or decimal digit, analogous to m/[[:alnum:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isALPHANUMERIC_A
, isALPHANUMERIC_L1
, isALPHANUMERIC_uvchr
, isALPHANUMERIC_utf8_safe
, isALPHANUMERIC_LC
, isALPHANUMERIC_LC_uvchr
, and isALPHANUMERIC_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isALPHANUMERIC(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is one of the 128 characters in the ASCII character set, analogous to m/[[:ascii:]]/
. On non-ASCII platforms, it returns TRUE iff this character corresponds to an ASCII character. Variants isASCII_A()
and isASCII_L1()
are identical to isASCII()
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isASCII_uvchr
, isASCII_utf8_safe
, isASCII_LC
, isASCII_LC_uvchr
, and isASCII_LC_utf8_safe
. Note, however, that some platforms do not have the C library routine isascii()
. In these cases, the variants whose names contain LC
are the same as the corresponding ones without.
Also note, that because all ASCII characters are UTF-8 invariant (meaning they have the exact same representation (always a single byte) whether encoded in UTF-8 or not), isASCII
will give the correct results when called with any byte in any string encoded or not in UTF-8. And similarly isASCII_utf8_safe
will work properly on any string encoded or not in UTF-8.
bool isASCII(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a character considered to be a blank, analogous to m/[[:blank:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isBLANK_A
, isBLANK_L1
, isBLANK_uvchr
, isBLANK_utf8_safe
, isBLANK_LC
, isBLANK_LC_uvchr
, and isBLANK_LC_utf8_safe
. Note, however, that some platforms do not have the C library routine isblank()
. In these cases, the variants whose names contain LC
are the same as the corresponding ones without.
bool isBLANK(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a control character, analogous to m/[[:cntrl:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isCNTRL_A
, isCNTRL_L1
, isCNTRL_uvchr
, isCNTRL_utf8_safe
, isCNTRL_LC
, isCNTRL_LC_uvchr
, and isCNTRL_LC_utf8_safe
On EBCDIC platforms, you almost always want to use the isCNTRL_L1
variant.
bool isCNTRL(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a digit, analogous to m/[[:digit:]]/
. Variants isDIGIT_A
and isDIGIT_L1
are identical to isDIGIT
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isDIGIT_uvchr
, isDIGIT_utf8_safe
, isDIGIT_LC
, isDIGIT_LC_uvchr
, and isDIGIT_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isDIGIT(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a graphic character, analogous to m/[[:graph:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isGRAPH_A
, isGRAPH_L1
, isGRAPH_uvchr
, isGRAPH_utf8_safe
, isGRAPH_LC
, isGRAPH_LC_uvchr
, and isGRAPH_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isGRAPH(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character can be the second or succeeding character of an identifier. This is very close to, but not quite the same as the official Unicode property XID_Continue
. The difference is that this returns true only if the input character also matches "isWORDCHAR". See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isIDCONT_A
, isIDCONT_L1
, isIDCONT_uvchr
, isIDCONT_utf8_safe
, isIDCONT_LC
, isIDCONT_LC_uvchr
, and isIDCONT_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isIDCONT(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character can be the first character of an identifier. This is very close to, but not quite the same as the official Unicode property XID_Start
. The difference is that this returns true only if the input character also matches "isWORDCHAR". See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isIDFIRST_A
, isIDFIRST_L1
, isIDFIRST_uvchr
, isIDFIRST_utf8_safe
, isIDFIRST_LC
, isIDFIRST_LC_uvchr
, and isIDFIRST_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isIDFIRST(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a lowercase character, analogous to m/[[:lower:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isLOWER_A
, isLOWER_L1
, isLOWER_uvchr
, isLOWER_utf8_safe
, isLOWER_LC
, isLOWER_LC_uvchr
, and isLOWER_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isLOWER(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an octal digit, [0-7]. The only two variants are isOCTAL_A
and isOCTAL_L1
; each is identical to isOCTAL
.
bool isOCTAL(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a printable character, analogous to m/[[:print:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isPRINT_A
, isPRINT_L1
, isPRINT_uvchr
, isPRINT_utf8_safe
, isPRINT_LC
, isPRINT_LC_uvchr
, and isPRINT_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isPRINT(char ch)
(short for Posix Space) Starting in 5.18, this is identical in all its forms to the corresponding isSPACE()
macros. The locale forms of this macro are identical to their corresponding isSPACE()
forms in all Perl releases. In releases prior to 5.18, the non-locale forms differ from their isSPACE()
forms only in that the isSPACE()
forms don't match a Vertical Tab, and the isPSXSPC()
forms do. Otherwise they are identical. Thus this macro is analogous to what m/[[:space:]]/
matches in a regular expression. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isPSXSPC_A
, isPSXSPC_L1
, isPSXSPC_uvchr
, isPSXSPC_utf8_safe
, isPSXSPC_LC
, isPSXSPC_LC_uvchr
, and isPSXSPC_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isPSXSPC(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a punctuation character, analogous to m/[[:punct:]]/
. Note that the definition of what is punctuation isn't as straightforward as one might desire. See "POSIX Character Classes" in perlrecharclass for details. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isPUNCT_A
, isPUNCT_L1
, isPUNCT_uvchr
, isPUNCT_utf8_safe
, isPUNCT_LC
, isPUNCT_LC_uvchr
, and isPUNCT_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isPUNCT(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a whitespace character. This is analogous to what m/\s/
matches in a regular expression. Starting in Perl 5.18 this also matches what m/[[:space:]]/
does. Prior to 5.18, only the locale forms of this macro (the ones with LC
in their names) matched precisely what m/[[:space:]]/
does. In those releases, the only difference, in the non-locale variants, was that isSPACE()
did not match a vertical tab. (See "isPSXSPC" for a macro that matches a vertical tab in all releases.) See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isSPACE_A
, isSPACE_L1
, isSPACE_uvchr
, isSPACE_utf8_safe
, isSPACE_LC
, isSPACE_LC_uvchr
, and isSPACE_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isSPACE(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is an uppercase character, analogous to m/[[:upper:]]/
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isUPPER_A
, isUPPER_L1
, isUPPER_uvchr
, isUPPER_utf8_safe
, isUPPER_LC
, isUPPER_LC_uvchr
, and isUPPER_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isUPPER(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a character that is a word character, analogous to what m/\w/
and m/[[:word:]]/
match in a regular expression. A word character is an alphabetic character, a decimal digit, a connecting punctuation character (such as an underscore), or a "mark" character that attaches to one of those (like some sort of accent). isALNUM()
is a synonym provided for backward compatibility, even though a word character includes more than the standard C language meaning of alphanumeric. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isWORDCHAR_A
, isWORDCHAR_L1
, isWORDCHAR_uvchr
, and isWORDCHAR_utf8_safe
. isWORDCHAR_LC
, isWORDCHAR_LC_uvchr
, and isWORDCHAR_LC_utf8_safe
are also as described there, but additionally include the platform's native underscore.
bool isWORDCHAR(char ch)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified character is a hexadecimal digit. In the ASCII range these are [0-9A-Fa-f]
. Variants isXDIGIT_A()
and isXDIGIT_L1()
are identical to isXDIGIT()
. See the top of this section for an explanation of variants isXDIGIT_uvchr
, isXDIGIT_utf8_safe
, isXDIGIT_LC
, isXDIGIT_LC_uvchr
, and isXDIGIT_LC_utf8_safe
.
bool isXDIGIT(char ch)
Performs the default fixup of the arguments part of an entersub
op tree. This consists of applying list context to each of the argument ops. This is the standard treatment used on a call marked with &
, or a method call, or a call through a subroutine reference, or any other call where the callee can't be identified at compile time, or a call where the callee has no prototype.
OP * ck_entersub_args_list(OP *entersubop)
Performs the fixup of the arguments part of an entersub
op tree based on a subroutine prototype. This makes various modifications to the argument ops, from applying context up to inserting refgen
ops, and checking the number and syntactic types of arguments, as directed by the prototype. This is the standard treatment used on a subroutine call, not marked with &
, where the callee can be identified at compile time and has a prototype.
protosv supplies the subroutine prototype or signature to be applied to the call, or indicates that there is no prototype. It may be a normal scalar, in which case if it is defined then the string value will be used as a prototype, and if it is undefined then there is no prototype. Alternatively, for convenience, it may be a subroutine object (a CV*
that has been cast to SV*
), of which the prototype or signature will be used if it has one. The prototype (or lack thereof) supplied, in whichever form, does not need to match the actual callee referenced by the op tree. If the protosv has no prototype but a signature, the prototype is automatically created from the signature.
If the argument ops disagree with the prototype, for example by having an unacceptable number of arguments or a wrong argument type, a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. In the error message, the callee is referred to by the name defined by the namegv parameter.
OP * ck_entersub_args_proto(OP *entersubop,
GV *namegv, SV *protosv)
Performs the fixup of the arguments part of an entersub
op tree either based on a subroutine signature, prototype or using default list-context processing. This is the standard treatment used on a subroutine call, not marked with &
, where the callee can be identified at compile time.
Note: Methods or computed functions need to do this run-time.
See "ck_entersub_args_signature" in perlapi for the handling with a defined protosv
signature, and "ck_entersub_args_proto" in perlapi with an old-style prototype.
OP * ck_entersub_args_proto_or_list(OP *entersubop,
GV *namegv,
SV *protosv)
Performs the fixup and compile-time checks of the arguments part of an entersub
op tree based on a subroutine signature. This makes various modifications to the argument ops, from applying context up to inserting refgen
ops, checking the number and types of arguments, and adding run-time type casts as directed by the signature. This is the standard treatment used on a signatured non-method call, not marked with &
, where the callee can be identified at compile time and has a signature.
If the argument ops, the args, disagree with the signature, for example by having an unacceptable number of arguments or a wrong argument type, a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. In the error message, the callee is referred to by the name defined by the namegv parameter.
With an CvEXTERN ensure that all declared types uniquely match FFI C types.
OP * ck_entersub_args_signature(OP *entersubop,
GV *namegv,
CV *protosv)
The original form of "cv_get_call_checker_flags", which does not return checker flags. When using a checker function returned by this function, it is only safe to call it with a genuine GV as its namegv
argument.
void cv_get_call_checker(CV *cv,
Perl_call_checker *ckfun_p,
SV **ckobj_p)
Retrieves the function that will be used to fix up a call to the cv
to override the default signature handling or suppress evaluation of the args (i.e. macros). Specifically, the function is applied to an entersub
op tree for a subroutine call, not marked with &
, where the callee can be identified at compile time as cv
.
The C-level function pointer is returned in *ckfun_p
, an SV argument for it is returned in *ckobj_p
, and control flags are returned in *ckflags_p
. The function is intended to be called in this manner:
entersubop = (*ckfun_p)(aTHX_ entersubop, namegv, (*ckobj_p));
In this call, entersubop
is a pointer to the entersub
op, which may be replaced by the check function, and namegv
supplies the name that should be used by the check function to refer to the callee of the entersub
op if it needs to emit any diagnostics. It is permitted to apply the check function in non-standard situations, such as to a call to a different subroutine or to a method call.
namegv
may not actually be a GV. If the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit is clear in *ckflags_p
, it is permitted to pass a CV or other SV instead, anything that can be used as the first argument to "cv_name". If the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit is set in *ckflags_p
then the check function requires namegv
to be a genuine GV.
By default, the check function is Perl_ck_entersub_args_proto_or_list, the SV parameter is cv
itself, and the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
flag is clear. This implements standard prototype processing. It can be changed, for a particular subroutine, by "cv_set_call_checker_flags".
If the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit is set in gflags
then it indicates that the caller only knows about the genuine GV version of namegv
, and accordingly the corresponding bit will always be set in *ckflags_p
, regardless of the check function's recorded requirements. If the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit is clear in gflags
then it indicates the caller knows about the possibility of passing something other than a GV as namegv
, and accordingly the corresponding bit may be either set or clear in *ckflags_p
, indicating the check function's recorded requirements.
gflags
is a bitset passed into cv_get_call_checker_flags
, in which only the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit currently has a defined meaning (for which see above). All other bits should be clear.
void cv_get_call_checker_flags(
CV *cv, U32 gflags,
Perl_call_checker *ckfun_p, SV **ckobj_p,
U32 *ckflags_p
)
The original form of "cv_set_call_checker_flags", which passes it the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
flag for backward-compatibility. The effect of that flag setting is that the check function is guaranteed to get a genuine GV as its namegv
argument.
void cv_set_call_checker(CV *cv,
Perl_call_checker ckfun,
SV *ckobj)
Sets the function that will be used to fix up a call to cv
. Specifically, the function is applied to an entersub
op tree for a subroutine call, not marked with &
, where the callee can be identified at compile time as cv
.
The C-level function pointer is supplied in ckfun
, an SV argument for it is supplied in ckobj
, and control flags are supplied in ckflags
. The function should be defined like this:
static OP * ckfun(pTHX_ OP *op, GV *namegv, SV *ckobj)
It is intended to be called in this manner:
entersubop = ckfun(aTHX_ entersubop, namegv, ckobj);
In this call, entersubop
is a pointer to the entersub
op, which may be replaced by the check function, and namegv
supplies the name that should be used by the check function to refer to the callee of the entersub
op if it needs to emit any diagnostics. It is permitted to apply the check function in non-standard situations, such as to a call to a different subroutine or to a method call.
namegv
may not actually be a GV. For efficiency, perl may pass a CV or other SV instead. Whatever is passed can be used as the first argument to "cv_name". You can force perl to pass a GV by including CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
in the ckflags
.
ckflags
is a bitset, in which only the CALL_CHECKER_REQUIRE_GV
bit currently has a defined meaning (for which see above). All other bits should be clear.
The current setting for a particular CV can be retrieved by "cv_get_call_checker_flags".
void cv_set_call_checker_flags(
CV *cv, Perl_call_checker ckfun, SV *ckobj,
U32 ckflags
)
Examines an op, which is expected to identify a subroutine at runtime, and attempts to determine at compile time which subroutine it identifies. This is normally used during Perl compilation to determine whether a prototype can be applied to a function call. cvop
is the op being considered, normally an rv2cv
op. A pointer to the identified subroutine is returned, if it could be determined statically, and a null pointer is returned if it was not possible to determine statically.
Currently, the subroutine can be identified statically if the RV that the rv2cv
is to operate on is provided by a suitable gv
or const
op. A gv
op is suitable if the GV's CV slot is populated. A const
op is suitable if the constant value must be an RV pointing to a CV. Details of this process may change in future versions of Perl. If the rv2cv
op has the OPpENTERSUB_AMPER
flag set then no attempt is made to identify the subroutine statically: this flag is used to suppress compile-time magic on a subroutine call, forcing it to use default runtime behaviour.
If flags
has the bit RV2CVOPCV_MARK_EARLY
set, then the handling of a GV reference is modified. If a GV was examined and its CV slot was found to be empty, then the gv
op has the OPpEARLY_CV
flag set. If the op is not optimised away, and the CV slot is later populated with a subroutine having a prototype, that flag eventually triggers the warning "called too early to check prototype".
If flags
has the bit RV2CVOPCV_RETURN_NAME_GV
set, then instead of returning a pointer to the subroutine it returns a pointer to the GV giving the most appropriate name for the subroutine in this context. Normally this is just the CvGV
of the subroutine, but for an anonymous (CvANON
) subroutine that is referenced through a GV it will be the referencing GV. The resulting GV*
is cast to CV*
to be returned. A null pointer is returned as usual if there is no statically-determinable subroutine.
CV * rv2cv_op_cv(OP *cvop, U32 flags)
Create and return a new interpreter by cloning the current one.
perl_clone
takes these flags as parameters:
CLONEf_COPY_STACKS
- is used to, well, copy the stacks also, without it we only clone the data and zero the stacks, with it we copy the stacks and the new perl interpreter is ready to run at the exact same point as the previous one. The pseudo-fork code uses COPY_STACKS
while the threads->create doesn't.
CLONEf_KEEP_PTR_TABLE
- perl_clone
keeps a ptr_table with the pointer of the old variable as a key and the new variable as a value, this allows it to check if something has been cloned and not clone it again but rather just use the value and increase the refcount. If KEEP_PTR_TABLE
is not set then perl_clone
will kill the ptr_table using the function ptr_table_free(PL_ptr_table); PL_ptr_table = NULL;
, reason to keep it around is if you want to dup some of your own variable who are outside the graph perl scans, an example of this code is in threads.xs create.
CLONEf_CLONE_HOST
- This is a win32 thing, it is ignored on unix, it tells perls win32host code (which is c++) to clone itself, this is needed on win32 if you want to run two threads at the same time, if you just want to do some stuff in a separate perl interpreter and then throw it away and return to the original one, you don't need to do anything.
PerlInterpreter* perl_clone(
PerlInterpreter *proto_perl,
UV flags
)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Temporarily disable an entry in this BHK structure, by clearing the appropriate flag. which
is a preprocessor token indicating which entry to disable.
void BhkDISABLE(BHK *hk, which)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Re-enable an entry in this BHK structure, by setting the appropriate flag. which
is a preprocessor token indicating which entry to enable. This will assert (under -DDEBUGGING) if the entry doesn't contain a valid pointer.
void BhkENABLE(BHK *hk, which)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Set an entry in the BHK structure, and set the flags to indicate it is valid. which
is a preprocessing token indicating which entry to set. The type of ptr
depends on the entry.
void BhkENTRY_set(BHK *hk, which, void *ptr)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Register a set of hooks to be called when the Perl lexical scope changes at compile time. See "Compile-time scope hooks" in perlguts.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_blockhook_register with an aTHX_ parameter.
void Perl_blockhook_register(pTHX_ BHK *hk)
Return i'th field padoffset or NOT_IN_PAD
. PADOFFSET field_index(const HV* klass, U16 i)
Returns the pad offset in comppad_name
for the field in the klass, or NOT_IN_PAD
if not found.
If klen is negative, the key is UTF8. PADOFFSET field_pad(const HV* klass, const char* key, I32 klen)
Adds the fieldname (without the '$') with its compile-time padoffset to the %klass.
If klen is negative, the hash key is UTF8. Even if the klen argument is provided, the fieldname may not contain a NULL character.
The old API is to add the pad to the @class::FIELDS array, and the name with the index of the field to the %class::FIELDS hash.
The new API is via methods only, with a single buffer of name\0pad entries, the search is be linear in a string buffer. The typical numbers are 1-3 - 20 fields per class. The padsize will be dynamic eventually, currently sizeof(long).
The list of name/pad pairs always needs to end with a \0 char.
void field_pad_add(HV* klass, const char* key,
I32 klen, PADOFFSET targ)
Searches for the fieldname without the '$' in %class::
If klen is negative, the hash key is UTF8.
Returns -1
if not found. Returns the field index in the object/class fields list and with *po
set, sets there the padoffset into comppad. int field_search(const HV* klass, const char* key, I32 klen, PADOFFSET *po)
Length of the "HvFIELDS" buffer in "HvAUX".
int fields_size(char* fields)
Number of fields in the klass. U16 numfields(const HV* klass)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Generates and returns a standard Perl hash representing the full set of key/value pairs in the cop hints hash cophh
. flags
is currently unused and must be zero.
HV * cophh_2hv(const COPHH *cophh, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Make and return a complete copy of the cop hints hash cophh
.
COPHH * cophh_copy(COPHH *cophh)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_delete_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pv(const COPHH *cophh,
const char *key, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Delete a key and its associated value from the cop hints hash cophh
, and returns the modified hash. The returned hash pointer is in general not the same as the hash pointer that was passed in. The input hash is consumed by the function, and the pointer to it must not be subsequently used. Use "cophh_copy" if you need both hashes.
The key is specified by keypv
and keylen
. If flags
has the COPHH_KEY_UTF8
bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash
is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pvn(COPHH *cophh,
const char *keypv,
STRLEN keylen, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_delete_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
COPHH * cophh_delete_pvs(const COPHH *cophh,
"literal string" key,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_delete_pvn", but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_delete_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key,
U32 hash, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_fetch_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cophh_fetch_pv(const COPHH *cophh,
const char *key, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Look up the entry in the cop hints hash cophh
with the key specified by keypv
and keylen
. If flags
has the COPHH_KEY_UTF8
bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash
is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed. Returns a mortal scalar copy of the value associated with the key, or &PL_sv_placeholder
if there is no value associated with the key.
SV * cophh_fetch_pvn(const COPHH *cophh,
const char *keypv,
STRLEN keylen, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_fetch_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
SV * cophh_fetch_pvs(const COPHH *cophh,
"literal string" key, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_fetch_pvn", but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cophh_fetch_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key,
U32 hash, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Discard the cop hints hash cophh
, freeing all resources associated with it.
void cophh_free(COPHH *cophh)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Generate and return a fresh cop hints hash containing no entries.
COPHH * cophh_new_empty()
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_store_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_store_pv(const COPHH *cophh,
const char *key, U32 hash,
SV *value, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Stores a value, associated with a key, in the cop hints hash cophh
, and returns the modified hash. The returned hash pointer is in general not the same as the hash pointer that was passed in. The input hash is consumed by the function, and the pointer to it must not be subsequently used. Use "cophh_copy" if you need both hashes.
The key is specified by keypv
and keylen
. If flags
has the COPHH_KEY_UTF8
bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash
is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed.
value
is the scalar value to store for this key. value
is copied by this function, which thus does not take ownership of any reference to it, and later changes to the scalar will not be reflected in the value visible in the cop hints hash. Complex types of scalar will not be stored with referential integrity, but will be coerced to strings.
COPHH * cophh_store_pvn(COPHH *cophh, const char *keypv,
STRLEN keylen, U32 hash,
SV *value, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_store_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
COPHH * cophh_store_pvs(const COPHH *cophh,
"literal string" key, SV *value,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "cophh_store_pvn", but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
COPHH * cophh_store_sv(const COPHH *cophh, SV *key,
U32 hash, SV *value, U32 flags)
Generates and returns a standard Perl hash representing the full set of hint entries in the cop cop
. flags
is currently unused and must be zero.
HV * cop_hints_2hv(const COP *cop, U32 flags)
Like "cop_hints_fetch_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pv(const COP *cop,
const char *key, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
Look up the hint entry in the cop cop
with the key specified by keypv
and keylen
. If flags
has the COPHH_KEY_UTF8
bit set, the key octets are interpreted as UTF-8, otherwise they are interpreted as Latin-1. hash
is a precomputed hash of the key string, or zero if it has not been precomputed. Returns a mortal scalar copy of the value associated with the key, or &PL_sv_placeholder
if there is no value associated with the key.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pvn(const COP *cop,
const char *keypv,
STRLEN keylen, U32 hash,
U32 flags)
Like "cop_hints_fetch_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair, and no precomputed hash.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_pvs(const COP *cop,
"literal string" key,
U32 flags)
Like "cop_hints_fetch_pvn", but takes a Perl scalar instead of a string/length pair.
SV * cop_hints_fetch_sv(const COP *cop, SV *key,
U32 hash, U32 flags)
Register a custom op. See "Custom Operators" in perlguts.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_custom_op_register with an aTHX_ parameter.
void Perl_custom_op_register(pTHX_
Perl_ppaddr_t ppaddr,
const XOP *xop)
Return the XOP structure for a given custom op. This macro should be considered internal to OP_NAME
and the other access macros: use them instead. This macro does calls the function custom_op_get_field(). Prior to 5.19.6, this was implemented as a function.
NOTE: this function must be explicitly called as Perl_custom_op_xop with an aTHX_ parameter.
const XOP * Perl_custom_op_xop(pTHX_ const OP *o)
Temporarily disable a member of the XOP, by clearing the appropriate flag.
void XopDISABLE(XOP *xop, which)
Reenable a member of the XOP which has been disabled.
void XopENABLE(XOP *xop, which)
Return a member of the XOP structure. which
is a cpp token indicating which entry to return. If the member is not set this will return a default value. The return type depends on which
. This macro evaluates its arguments more than once. If you are using Perl_custom_op_xop
to retreive a XOP *
from a OP *
, use the more efficient "XopENTRYCUSTOM" instead.
void XopENTRY(XOP *xop, which)
Exactly like XopENTRY(XopENTRY(Perl_custom_op_xop(aTHX_ o), which)
but more efficient. The which
parameter is identical to "XopENTRY".
void XopENTRYCUSTOM(const OP *o, which)
Set a member of the XOP structure. which
is a cpp token indicating which entry to set. See "Custom Operators" in perlguts for details about the available members and how they are used. This macro evaluates its argument more than once.
void XopENTRY_set(XOP *xop, which, value)
Return the XOP's flags.
U32 XopFLAGS(XOP *xop)
This section documents functions to manipulate CVs which are code-values, or subroutines. For more information, see perlguts.
The XSUB-writer's equivalent of caller(). The returned PERL_CONTEXT
structure can be interrogated to find all the information returned to Perl by caller
. Note that XSUBs don't get a stack frame, so caller_cx(0, NULL)
will return information for the immediately-surrounding Perl code.
This function skips over the automatic calls to &DB::sub
made on the behalf of the debugger. If the stack frame requested was a sub called by DB::sub
, the return value will be the frame for the call to DB::sub
, since that has the correct line number/etc. for the call site. If dbcxp is non-NULL
, it will be set to a pointer to the frame for the sub call itself.
const PERL_CONTEXT * caller_cx(
I32 level,
const PERL_CONTEXT **dbcxp
)
Returns the stash of the CV. A stash is the symbol table hash, containing the package-scoped variables in the package where the subroutine was defined. For more information, see perlguts.
This also has a special use with XS AUTOLOAD subs. See "Autoloading with XSUBs" in perlguts.
HV* CvSTASH(CV* cv)
Locate the CV corresponding to the currently executing sub or eval. If db_seqp
is non_null, skip CVs that are in the DB package and populate *db_seqp
with the cop sequence number at the point that the DB:: code was entered. (This allows debuggers to eval in the scope of the breakpoint rather than in the scope of the debugger itself.)
CV* find_runcv(U32 *db_seqp)
Uses strlen
to get the length of name
, then calls get_cvn_flags
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
CV* get_cv(const char* name, I32 flags)
Returns the CV of the specified Perl subroutine. flags
are passed to gv_fetchpvn_flags
. If GV_ADD
is set and the Perl subroutine does not exist then it will be declared (which has the same effect as saying sub name;
). If GV_ADD
is not set and the subroutine does not exist then NULL is returned.
In cperl only.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
CV* get_cvn_flags(const char* name, STRLEN len,
I32 flags)
get_cvs("Name", flags)
to be used with a constant string.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
CV* get_cvs(const char* name, I32 flags)
xsubpp
variables and internal functionsVariable which is setup by xsubpp
to indicate the stack base offset, used by the ST
, XSprePUSH
and XSRETURN
macros. The dMARK
macro must be called prior to setup the MARK
variable.
I32 ax
Variable which is setup by xsubpp
to indicate the class name for a C++ XS constructor. This is always a char*
. See "THIS"
.
char* CLASS
Sets up the ax
variable. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
by calling dXSARGS
.
dAX;
Sets up the ax
variable and stack marker variable mark
. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
by calling dXSARGS
.
dAXMARK;
Sets up the items
variable. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
by calling dXSARGS
.
dITEMS;
Sets up any variable needed by the UNDERBAR
macro. It used to define padoff_du
, but it is currently a noop. However, it is strongly advised to still use it for ensuring past and future compatibility.
dUNDERBAR;
Sets up stack and mark pointers for an XSUB, calling dSP
and dMARK
. Sets up the ax
and items
variables by calling dAX
and dITEMS
. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
.
dXSARGS;
Sets up the ix
variable for an XSUB which has aliases. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
.
dXSI32;
Variable which is setup by xsubpp
to indicate the number of items on the stack. See "Variable-length Parameter Lists" in perlxs.
I32 items
Variable which is setup by xsubpp
to indicate which of an XSUB's aliases was used to invoke it. See "The ALIAS: Keyword" in perlxs.
I32 ix
Variable which is setup by xsubpp
to hold the return value for an XSUB. This is always the proper type for the XSUB. See "The RETVAL Variable" in perlxs.
(whatever) RETVAL
Used to access elements on the XSUB's stack.
SV* ST(int ix)
Variable which is setup by xsubpp
to designate the object in a C++ XSUB. This is always the proper type for the C++ object. See "CLASS"
and "Using XS With C++" in perlxs.
(whatever) THIS
The SV* corresponding to the $_
variable. Works even if there is a lexical $_
in scope.
Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list. This is handled by xsubpp
. It is the same as using the more explicit XS_EXTERNAL
macro.
Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list explicitly exporting the symbols.
Macro to declare an XSUB and its C parameter list without exporting the symbols. This is handled by xsubpp
and generally preferable over exporting the XSUB symbols unnecessarily.
Print the name of the op to stderr, used by -Dt
. Some ops are printed with an argument.
I32 debop(const OP* o)
Dumps a named gv name with given indent level to a IO.
void do_gvgv_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const char *name, GV *sv)
Dumps a named gv with given indent level to a IO.
void do_gv_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const char *name, GV *sv)
Dumps a named hv with given indent level to a IO.
void do_hv_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const char *name, HV *sv)
|I32 nest|I32 maxnest|bool dumpops|STRLEN pvlim
level: amount to indent the output
file: the IO to dump to
mg: the MAGIC to dump
nest: the current level of recursion
maxnest: the maximum allowed level of recursion,
also the max number of HV and AV elements listed.
dumpops: if true, also dump the ops associated with a CV
pvlim: limit on the length of any strings that are output
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void do_magic_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const MAGIC *mg, I32 nest,
I32 maxnest, bool dumpops,
STRLEN pvlim)
level: amount to indent the output
file: the IO to dump to
o: the op to dump
Observes the initial global PL_dumpindent
, default 4, e.g. set by Devel::Peek or B::C to 2. The internal op indent between ops is hardcoded to 2 with cperl, and 4 with perl5. NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void do_op_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file, const OP *o)
level: amount to indent the output
file: the IO to dump to
pm: the object to dump
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void do_pmop_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const PMOP *pm)
|I32 nest|I32 maxnest|bool dumpops|STRLEN pvlim
level: amount to indent the output
file: the IO to dump to
sv: the object to dump
nest: the current level of recursion
maxnest: the maximum allowed level of recursion,
also the max number of HV and AV elements listed.
dumpops: if true, also dump the ops associated with a CV
pvlim: limit on the length of any strings that are output
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void do_sv_dump(I32 level, PerlIO *file, SV *sv,
I32 nest, I32 maxnest, bool dumpops,
STRLEN pvlim)
Dumps the entire optree of the current program starting at PL_main_root
to STDERR
. Also dumps the optrees for all visible subroutines in %main::
, the PL_defstash
. But no XS subs or subs with empty bodies. See "dump_all_perl".
void dump_all()
Dumps the entire optree of the current program starting to STDERR
. Also dumps all SUBS in the %main:: package to STDERR
. See "dump_packsubs_perl".
void dump_all_perl(bool justperl)
Dumps the current eval_root
to STDERR
.
void dump_eval()
Dumps the FORMAT to STDERR
.
void dump_form(const GV* gv)
Dumps all perl-only SUBS in the package stash
to STDERR
. See "dump_packsubs_perl".
void dump_packsubs(const HV *stash)
Dumps all SUBS in the package to STDERR
. See "dump_sub_perl".
void dump_packsubs_perl(const HV *stash,
bool justperl)
Dumps the perl-only SUB to STDERR
. This accepts only a GV, not a CV or CVREF. A CVREF will be upgraded to a full GV. Rather use "dump_sub_cv" instead, cperl-only.
See also "dump_sub_perl".
void dump_sub(const GV* gv)
Dumps the SUB to STDERR
. This accepts only a CV, not a GV or CVREF. cperl-only.
See also "dump_sub".
void dump_sub_cv(CV* cv)
Dumps any SUB to STDERR
, optionally also XS and empty sub declarations. See also "dump_sub".
void dump_sub_perl(const GV* gv, bool justperl)
Dumps the string with arguments to the given IO, starting with a indent level of whitespace.
void dump_vindent(I32 level, PerlIO *file,
const char* pat, va_list *args)
Dumps a gv to STDERR
.
void gv_dump(GV* gv)
Dumps magic to STDERR
.
void magic_dump(const MAGIC *mg)
Given an op, determine what type of struct it has been allocated as. Returns one of the OPclass enums, such as OPclass_LISTOP.
OPclass op_class(const OP *o)
Dumps the optree starting at OP o
to STDERR
.
void op_dump(const OP *o)
Dumps the optree for cv starting at OP o
to STDERR
. This variant also prints padvar names.
void op_dump_cv(const OP *o, const CV *cv)
Dumps a pmop to STDERR
.
void pmop_dump(PMOP* pm)
The slow runloop used with -DDEBUGGING to observe all -D
flags, esp. -Dt
op tracing, -Ds
stack, -Dsv
verbose stack and -DP
profiling.
int runops_debug()
Dumps the contents of an SV to the STDERR
filehandle.
For an example of its output, see Devel::Peek. void sv_dump(SV* sv)
Similar to
pv_escape(dsv,pv,cur,pvlim,PERL_PV_ESCAPE_QUOTE);
except that an additional "\0" will be appended to the string when len > cur and pv[cur] is "\0".
Note that the final string may be up to 7 chars longer than pvlim.
char* pv_display(SV *dsv, const char *pv, STRLEN cur,
STRLEN len, STRLEN pvlim)
Escapes at most the first count
chars of pv
and puts the results into dsv
such that the size of the escaped string will not exceed max
chars and will not contain any incomplete escape sequences. The number of bytes escaped will be returned in the STRLEN *escaped
parameter if it is not null. When the dsv
parameter is null no escaping actually occurs, but the number of bytes that would be escaped were it not null will be calculated.
If flags contains PERL_PV_ESCAPE_QUOTE
then any double quotes in the string will also be escaped.
Normally the SV will be cleared before the escaped string is prepared, but when PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NOCLEAR
is set this will not occur.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_UNI
is set then the input string is treated as UTF-8 if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_UNI_DETECT
is set then the input string is scanned using is_utf8_string()
to determine if it is UTF-8.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_ALL
is set then all input chars will be output using \x01F1
style escapes, otherwise if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NONASCII
is set, only non-ASCII chars will be escaped using this style; otherwise, only chars above 255 will be so escaped; other non printable chars will use octal or common escaped patterns like \n
. Otherwise, if PERL_PV_ESCAPE_NOBACKSLASH
then all chars below 255 will be treated as printable and will be output as literals.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_FIRSTCHAR
is set then only the first char of the string will be escaped, regardless of max. If the output is to be in hex, then it will be returned as a plain hex sequence. Thus the output will either be a single char, an octal escape sequence, a special escape like \n
or a hex value.
If PERL_PV_ESCAPE_RE
is set then the escape char used will be a "%"
and not a "\\"
. This is because regexes very often contain backslashed sequences, whereas "%"
is not a particularly common character in patterns.
Returns a pointer to the escaped text as held by dsv
.
char* pv_escape(SV *dsv, char const * const str,
const STRLEN count, const STRLEN max,
STRLEN * const escaped,
const U32 flags)
Converts a string into something presentable, handling escaping via pv_escape()
and supporting quoting and ellipses.
If the PERL_PV_PRETTY_QUOTE
flag is set then the result will be double quoted with any double quotes in the string escaped. Otherwise if the PERL_PV_PRETTY_LTGT
flag is set then the result be wrapped in angle brackets.
If the PERL_PV_PRETTY_ELLIPSES
flag is set and not all characters in string were output then an ellipsis ...
will be appended to the string. Note that this happens AFTER it has been quoted.
If start_color
is non-null then it will be inserted after the opening quote (if there is one) but before the escaped text. If end_color
is non-null then it will be inserted after the escaped text but before any quotes or ellipses.
Returns a pointer to the prettified text as held by dsv
.
char* pv_pretty(SV *dsv, char const * const str,
const STRLEN count, const STRLEN max,
char const * const start_color,
char const * const end_color,
const U32 flags)
Returns a temporary string of the SV value.
char* sv_peek(SV* sv)
Clone a CV, making a lexical closure. proto
supplies the prototype of the function: its code, pad structure, and other attributes. The prototype is combined with a capture of outer lexicals to which the code refers, which are taken from the currently-executing instance of the immediately surrounding code.
CV * cv_clone(CV *proto)
Returns an SV containing the name of the CV, mainly for use in error reporting. The CV may actually be a GV instead, in which case the returned SV holds the GV's name. Anything other than a GV or CV is treated as a string already holding the sub name, but this could change in the future.
An SV may be passed as a second argument. If so, the name will be assigned to it and it will be returned. Otherwise the returned SV will be a new mortal.
If flags
has the CV_NAME_NOTQUAL
bit set, then the package name will not be included. If the first argument is neither a CV nor a GV, this flag is ignored (subject to change).
If the flags include CV_NAME_NOMAIN, then "main:::" will be omitted as package name. If the flags include CV_NAME_METHOD, then the last "::" will be printed as "->.
SV * cv_name(CV *cv, SV *sv, U32 flags)
Possibly optimizes the internal representation of the sub, esp. more expensive loop analysis or more expensive jit optimizations. For now does nothing.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void cv_study(CV *cv)
Clear out all the active components of a CV. This can happen either by an explicit undef &foo
, or by the reference count going to zero. In the former case, we keep the CvOUTSIDE
pointer, so that any anonymous children can still follow the full lexical scope chain.
void cv_undef(CV* cv)
Find and return the variable that is named $_
in the lexical scope of the currently-executing function. This may be a lexical $_
, or will otherwise be the global one.
SV * find_rundefsv()
Find the position of the lexical $_
in the pad of the currently-executing function. Returns the offset in the current pad, or NOT_IN_PAD
if there is no lexical $_
in scope (in which case the global one should be used instead). "find_rundefsv" is likely to be more convenient.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
PADOFFSET find_rundefsvoffset()
"Introduce" my
variables to visible status. This is called during parsing at the end of each statement to make lexical variables visible to subsequent statements.
U32 intro_my()
Loads the module whose name is pointed to by the string part of name
. Note that the actual module name, not its filename, should be given. Eg, "Foo::Bar" instead of "Foo/Bar.pm". ver, if specified and not NULL, provides version semantics similar to use Foo::Bar VERSION
. The optional trailing arguments can be used to specify arguments to the module's import()
method, similar to use Foo::Bar VERSION LIST
; their precise handling depends on the flags. The flags argument is a bitwise-ORed collection of any of PERL_LOADMOD_DENY
, PERL_LOADMOD_NOIMPORT
, or PERL_LOADMOD_IMPORT_OPS
(or 0 for no flags).
If PERL_LOADMOD_NOIMPORT
is set, the module is loaded as if with an empty import list, as in use Foo::Bar ()
; this is the only circumstance in which the trailing optional arguments may be omitted entirely. Otherwise, if PERL_LOADMOD_IMPORT_OPS
is set, the trailing arguments must consist of exactly one OP*
, containing the op tree that produces the relevant import arguments. Otherwise, the trailing arguments must all be SV*
values that will be used as import arguments; and the list must be terminated with (SV*) NULL
. If neither PERL_LOADMOD_NOIMPORT
nor PERL_LOADMOD_IMPORT_OPS
is set, the trailing NULL
pointer is needed even if no import arguments are desired. The reference count for each specified SV*
argument is decremented. In addition, the name
argument is modified.
If PERL_LOADMOD_DENY
is set, the module is loaded as if with no
rather than use
.
void load_module(U32 flags, SV* name, SV* ver, ...)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Creates a new pad name list. max
is the highest index for which space is allocated.
PADNAMELIST * newPADNAMELIST(size_t max)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Constructs and returns a new pad name. Only use this function for names that refer to outer lexicals. (See also "newPADNAMEpvn".) outer
is the outer pad name that this one mirrors. The returned pad name has the PADNAMEt_OUTER
flag already set.
PADNAME * newPADNAMEouter(PADNAME *outer)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Constructs and returns a new pad name. s
must be a UTF-8 string. Do not use this for pad names that point to outer lexicals. See "newPADNAMEouter"
.
For backcompat the created name has always the UTF8 flag, see "newPADNAMEpvn_flags" instead.
PADNAME * newPADNAMEpvn(const char *s, STRLEN len)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The variant for "newPADNAMEpvn" which accepts a flags value of 0
for non-utf8 names. flags might be 0 or non-zero for UTF8.
PADNAME * newPADNAMEpvn_flags(const char *s, STRLEN len,
U32 flags)
Stub that provides thread hook for perl_destruct when there are no threads.
int nothreadhook()
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad (via "pad_alloc") for an anonymous function that is lexically scoped inside the currently-compiling function. The function func
is linked into the pad, and its CvOUTSIDE
link to the outer scope is weakened to avoid a reference loop.
One reference count is stolen, so you may need to do SvREFCNT_inc(func)
.
optype
should be an opcode indicating the type of operation that the pad entry is to support. This doesn't affect operational semantics, but is used for debugging.
PADOFFSET pad_add_anon(CV *func, I32 optype)
Exactly like "pad_add_name_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pv(const char *name, U32 flags,
HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad for a named lexical variable. Stores the name and other metadata in the name part of the pad, and makes preparations to manage the variable's lexical scoping. Returns the offset of the allocated pad slot.
namepv
/namelen
specify the variable's name, including leading sigil. If typestash
is non-null, the name is for a typed lexical, and this identifies the type. If ourstash
is non-null, it's a lexical reference to a package variable, and this identifies the package. The following flags can be OR'ed together:
padadd_OUR redundantly specifies if it's a package var
padadd_STATE variable will retain value persistently
padadd_NO_DUP_CHECK skip check for lexical shadowing
padadd_UTF8
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pvn(const char *namepv,
STRLEN namelen, U32 flags,
HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
Exactly like "pad_add_name_pvn", but takes the name string in the form of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_sv(SV *name, U32 flags,
HV *typestash, HV *ourstash)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Allocates a place in the currently-compiling pad, returning the offset of the allocated pad slot. No name is initially attached to the pad slot. tmptype
is a set of flags indicating the kind of pad entry required, which will be set in the value SV for the allocated pad entry:
SVs_PADMY named lexical variable ("my", "our", "state")
SVs_PADTMP unnamed temporary store
SVf_READONLY constant shared between recursion levels
SVf_READONLY
has been supported here only since perl 5.20. To work with earlier versions as well, use SVf_READONLY|SVs_PADTMP
. SVf_READONLY
does not cause the SV in the pad slot to be marked read-only, but simply tells pad_alloc
that it will be made read-only (by the caller), or at least should be treated as such.
optype
should be an opcode indicating the type of operation that the pad entry is to support. This doesn't affect operational semantics, but is used for debugging.
PADOFFSET pad_alloc(I32 optype, U32 tmptype)
Exactly like "pad_findmy_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
flags must be 0. PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pv(const char *name, U32 flags)
Given the name of a lexical variable, find its position in the currently-compiling pad. namepv
/namelen
specify the variable's name, including leading sigil. flags
is reserved and must be zero. (Pads are all UTF8 in cperl) If it is not in the current pad but appears in the pad of any lexically enclosing scope, then a pseudo-entry for it is added in the current pad. Returns the offset in the current pad, or NOT_IN_PAD
if no such lexical is in scope.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pvn(const char *namepv,
STRLEN namelen, U32 flags)
Search the pad for a real SV in all outer SVs from the current CV up. Skip inner FAKE pads until we get the real outer curpad slot.
Note that only with PL_compcv
at compile-time we will encounter fake pads. At runtime the current cv padlist has proper pads.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* pad_findmy_real(PADOFFSET po, CV* cv)
Search the pad for a real SV in all outer SVs from the current CV up. Skip inner FAKE pads until we get the real outer curpad slot.
Note that only with PL_compcv
at compile-time we will encounter fake pads. At runtime the current cv padlist has proper pads.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_realoffset(PADOFFSET po, CV* cv)
Exactly like "pad_findmy_pvn", but takes the name string in the form of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
flags must be 0, all pads are utf8 PADOFFSET pad_findmy_sv(SV *name, U32 flags)
Search the real pad offset in one of the outer CVs for the fake pad entry in the current CV, usually the PL_compcv
. See "pad_findmy_real".
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* pad_find_outer(PADNAME *pn, CV* cv)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Fetches the pad name from the given index.
PADNAME * padnamelist_fetch(PADNAMELIST *pnl,
SSize_t key)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Stores the pad name (which may be null) at the given index, freeing any existing pad name in that slot.
PADNAME ** padnamelist_store(PADNAMELIST *pnl,
SSize_t key, PADNAME *val)
Set the value at offset po
in the current (compiling or executing) pad. Use the macro PAD_SETSV()
rather than calling this function directly.
void pad_setsv(PADOFFSET po, SV *sv)
Get the value at offset po
in the current (compiling or executing) pad. Use macro PAD_SV
instead of calling this function directly.
SV * pad_sv(PADOFFSET po)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Tidy up a pad at the end of compilation of the code to which it belongs. Jobs performed here are: remove most stuff from the pads of anonsub prototypes; give it a @_
; mark temporaries as such. type
indicates the kind of subroutine:
padtidy_SUB ordinary subroutine
padtidy_SUBCLONE prototype for lexical closure
padtidy_FORMAT format
void pad_tidy(padtidy_type type)
Allocates a new Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
PerlInterpreter* perl_alloc()
Initializes a new Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
void perl_construct(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
Shuts down a Perl interpreter. See perlembed for a tutorial.
my_perl
points to the Perl interpreter. It must have been previously created through the use of "perl_alloc" and "perl_construct". It may have been initialised through "perl_parse", and may have been used through "perl_run" and other means. This function should be called for any Perl interpreter that has been constructed with "perl_construct", even if subsequent operations on it failed, for example if "perl_parse" returned a non-zero value.
If the interpreter's PL_exit_flags
word has the PERL_EXIT_DESTRUCT_END
flag set, then this function will execute code in END
blocks before performing the rest of destruction. If it is desired to make any use of the interpreter between "perl_parse" and "perl_destruct" other than just calling "perl_run", then this flag should be set early on. This matters if "perl_run" will not be called, or if anything else will be done in addition to calling "perl_run".
Returns a value be a suitable value to pass to the C library function exit
(or to return from main
), to serve as an exit code indicating the nature of the way the interpreter terminated. This takes into account any failure of "perl_parse" and any early exit from "perl_run". The exit code is of the type required by the host operating system, so because of differing exit code conventions it is not portable to interpret specific numeric values as having specific meanings.
int perl_destruct(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
Releases a Perl interpreter. See perlembed.
void perl_free(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
Tells a Perl interpreter to parse a Perl script. This performs most of the initialisation of a Perl interpreter. See perlembed for a tutorial.
my_perl
points to the Perl interpreter that is to parse the script. It must have been previously created through the use of "perl_alloc" and "perl_construct". xsinit
points to a callback function that will be called to set up the ability for this Perl interpreter to load XS extensions, or may be null to perform no such setup.
argc
and argv
supply a set of command-line arguments to the Perl interpreter, as would normally be passed to the main
function of a C program. argv[argc]
must be null. These arguments are where the script to parse is specified, either by naming a script file or by providing a script in a -e
option. If $0
will be written to in the Perl interpreter, then the argument strings must be in writable memory, and so mustn't just be string constants.
env
specifies a set of environment variables that will be used by this Perl interpreter. If non-null, it must point to a null-terminated array of environment strings. If null, the Perl interpreter will use the environment supplied by the environ
global variable.
This function initialises the interpreter, and parses and compiles the script specified by the command-line arguments. This includes executing code in BEGIN
, UNITCHECK
, and CHECK
blocks. It does not execute INIT
blocks or the main program.
Returns an integer of slightly tricky interpretation. The correct use of the return value is as a truth value indicating whether there was a failure in initialisation. If zero is returned, this indicates that initialisation was successful, and it is safe to proceed to call "perl_run" and make other use of it. If a non-zero value is returned, this indicates some problem that means the interpreter wants to terminate. The interpreter should not be just abandoned upon such failure; the caller should proceed to shut the interpreter down cleanly with "perl_destruct" and free it with "perl_free".
For historical reasons, the non-zero return value also attempts to be a suitable value to pass to the C library function exit
(or to return from main
), to serve as an exit code indicating the nature of the way initialisation terminated. However, this isn't portable, due to differing exit code conventions. A historical bug is preserved for the time being: if the Perl built-in exit
is called during this function's execution, with a type of exit entailing a zero exit code under the host operating system's conventions, then this function returns zero rather than a non-zero value. This bug, [perl #2754], leads to perl_run
being called (and therefore INIT
blocks and the main program running) despite a call to exit
. It has been preserved because a popular module-installing module has come to rely on it and needs time to be fixed. This issue is [perl #132577], and the original bug is due to be fixed in Perl 5.30.
int perl_parse(PerlInterpreter *my_perl,
XSINIT_t xsinit, int argc,
char **argv, char **env)
Tells a Perl interpreter to run its main program. See perlembed for a tutorial.
my_perl
points to the Perl interpreter. It must have been previously created through the use of "perl_alloc" and "perl_construct", and initialised through "perl_parse". This function should not be called if "perl_parse" returned a non-zero value, indicating a failure in initialisation or compilation.
This function executes code in INIT
blocks, and then executes the main program. The code to be executed is that established by the prior call to "perl_parse". If the interpreter's PL_exit_flags
word does not have the PERL_EXIT_DESTRUCT_END
flag set, then this function will also execute code in END
blocks. If it is desired to make any further use of the interpreter after calling this function, then END
blocks should be postponed to "perl_destruct" time by setting that flag.
Returns an integer of slightly tricky interpretation. The correct use of the return value is as a truth value indicating whether the program terminated non-locally. If zero is returned, this indicates that the program ran to completion, and it is safe to make other use of the interpreter (provided that the PERL_EXIT_DESTRUCT_END
flag was set as described above). If a non-zero value is returned, this indicates that the interpreter wants to terminate early. The interpreter should not be just abandoned because of this desire to terminate; the caller should proceed to shut the interpreter down cleanly with "perl_destruct" and free it with "perl_free".
For historical reasons, the non-zero return value also attempts to be a suitable value to pass to the C library function exit
(or to return from main
), to serve as an exit code indicating the nature of the way the program terminated. However, this isn't portable, due to differing exit code conventions. An attempt is made to return an exit code of the type required by the host operating system, but because it is constrained to be non-zero, it is not necessarily possible to indicate every type of exit. It is only reliable on Unix, where a zero exit code can be augmented with a set bit that will be ignored. In any case, this function is not the correct place to acquire an exit code: one should get that from "perl_destruct".
int perl_run(PerlInterpreter *my_perl)
Tells Perl to require
the file named by the string argument. It is analogous to the Perl code eval "require '$file'"
. It's even implemented that way; consider using load_module instead.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void require_pv(const char* pv)
Set up necessary local variables for exception handling. See "Exception Handling" in perlguts.
dXCPT;
Introduces a catch block. See "Exception Handling" in perlguts.
Rethrows a previously caught exception. See "Exception Handling" in perlguts.
XCPT_RETHROW;
Ends a try block. See "Exception Handling" in perlguts.
Starts a try block. See "Exception Handling" in perlguts.
Converts the mode char to a layer name, as possibly specified by the open pragma.
E.g. "r" under HINT_LEXICAL_IO_IN => "open<" "w" under HINT_LEXICAL_IO_OUT => "open>"
const char * PerlIO_context_layers(const char *mode)
Returns the current stderr PerlIO handle, used for debugging output.
PerlIO * PerlIO_debugio()
XS API for the T_STDIO
typemap, to open an IO handle with the :stdio
layer. Meaning it has an associated FILE*
handle and fd
file descriptor, and the PerlIO refcount associated with the fd will be bumped to avoid closing already open files, when the associated variable goes out of scope.
Note that calls to "PerlIO_exportFILE(f,mode)" in perlapio are reversed using "PerlIO_releaseFILE(p,f)" in perlapio, not "PerlIO_importFILE(f,mode)" in perlapio.
FILE * PerlIO_exportFILE(PerlIO *f, const char* mode)
Returns the fill state of the given PerlIO handle.
int PerlIO_fill(PerlIO *f)
Returns a native FILE * used by a stdio layer. If there is none, it will create one with "PerlIO_exportFILE". In either case the FILE * should be considered as belonging to the PerlIO subsystem and should only be closed by calling "PerlIO_close(f)" in perlapio.
See also "PerlIO_findFILE(f)" in perlapio. FILE * PerlIO_findFILE(PerlIO *f)
XS API for the T_STDIO
typemap, to release an :stdio IO handle opened with "PerlIO_exportFILE".
See "PerlIO_releaseFILE(p,f)" in perlapio void PerlIO_releaseFILE(PerlIO *p, FILE *f)
Calls unread on the given PerlIO handle, skipping back count characters from the input handle, if possible. Similar to ungetc
.
SSize_t PerlIO_unread(PerlIO *f, const void *vbuf,
Size_t count)
Really just call the ffi, handling also the signature (type checking and conversion) and retval (conversion). Without useffi we do accept extern () :void subs, without DynaLoader we always error with "Null extern sub symbol". We also throw the same error if the extern sub symbol was not found. pp_enterffi()
handles refcounting and freeing the perl core regexp structure. When it is necessary to actually free the structure the first thing it does is call the 'free' method of the regexp_engine associated to the regexp, allowing the handling of the void *pprivate
member first. (This routine is not overridable by extensions, which is why the extensions free is called first.)
See regdupe
and "regdupe_internal" if you change anything here. void pregfree(REGEXP* r)
|NN CLONE_PARAMS* param
duplicate a regexp.
This routine is expected to clone a given regexp structure. It is only compiled under USE_ITHREADS.
After all of the core data stored in struct regexp is duplicated the regexp_engine->dupe
method is used to copy any private data stored in the *pprivate
pointer. This allows extensions to handle any duplication it needs to do.
See "pregfree" and "regfree_internal" if you change anything here. NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void re_dup_guts(const REGEXP *sstr, REGEXP *dstr,
CLONE_PARAMS* param)
This is the internal complement to regdupe
which is used to copy the structure pointed to by the *pprivate
pointer in the regexp. This is the core version of the extension overridable cloning hook. The regexp structure being duplicated will be copied by perl prior to this and will be provided as the regexp *r argument, however with the /old/ structures pprivate
pointer value. Thus this routine may override any copying normally done by perl.
It returns a pointer to the new regexp_internal
structure. NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void* regdupe_internal(REGEXP * const r,
CLONE_PARAMS* param)
Free the private data in a regexp. This is overloadable by extensions. Perl takes care of the regexp structure in "pregfree", this covers the *pprivate
pointer which technically perl doesn't know about, however of course we have to handle the regexp_internal
structure when no extension is in use.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void regfree_internal(REGEXP *const rx)
dig the "next" pointer out of a node regnode* regnext(regnode* p)
Possibly optimizes the internal representation of a regex. E.g. jit with pcre2, prepares compiled utf and ascii patterns.
For now does nothing. NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void re_study(REGEXP *rx)
Saves the current GP of gv on the save stack to be restored on scope exit.
If empty is true, replace the GP with a new GP.
If empty is false, mark gv with GVf_INTRO so the next reference assigned is localized, which is how local *foo = $someref;
works.
void save_gp(GV* gv, I32 empty)
Used to indicate list context. See "GIMME_V"
, "GIMME"
and perlcall.
Indicates that arguments returned from a callback should be discarded. See perlcall.
Used to force a Perl eval
wrapper around a callback. See perlcall.
A backward-compatible version of GIMME_V
which can only return G_SCALAR
or G_ARRAY
; in a void context, it returns G_SCALAR
. Deprecated. Use GIMME_V
instead.
U32 GIMME
The XSUB-writer's equivalent to Perl's wantarray
. Returns G_VOID
, G_SCALAR
or G_ARRAY
for void, scalar or list context, respectively. See perlcall for a usage example.
U32 GIMME_V
Indicates that no arguments are being sent to a callback. See perlcall.
Used to indicate scalar context. See "GIMME_V"
, "GIMME"
, and perlcall.
These variables are global to an entire process. They are shared between all interpreters and all threads in a process. Any variables not documented here may be changed or removed without notice, so don't use them! If you feel you really do need to use an unlisted variable, first send email to perl5-porters@perl.org. It may be that someone there will point out a way to accomplish what you need without using an internal variable. But if not, you should get a go-ahead to document and then use the variable.
Array, indexed by opcode, of functions that will be called for the "check" phase of optree building during compilation of Perl code. For most (but not all) types of op, once the op has been initially built and populated with child ops it will be filtered through the check function referenced by the appropriate element of this array. The new op is passed in as the sole argument to the check function, and the check function returns the completed op. The check function may (as the name suggests) check the op for validity and signal errors. It may also initialise or modify parts of the ops, or perform more radical surgery such as adding or removing child ops, or even throw the op away and return a different op in its place.
This array of function pointers is a convenient place to hook into the compilation process. An XS module can put its own custom check function in place of any of the standard ones, to influence the compilation of a particular type of op. However, a custom check function must never fully replace a standard check function (or even a custom check function from another module). A module modifying checking must instead wrap the preexisting check function. A custom check function must be selective about when to apply its custom behaviour. In the usual case where it decides not to do anything special with an op, it must chain the preexisting op function. Check functions are thus linked in a chain, with the core's base checker at the end.
For thread safety, modules should not write directly to this array. Instead, use the function "wrap_op_checker".
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Function pointer, pointing at a function used to handle extended keywords. The function should be declared as
int keyword_plugin_function(pTHX_
char *keyword_ptr, STRLEN keyword_len,
OP **op_ptr)
The function is called from the tokeniser, whenever a possible keyword is seen. keyword_ptr
points at the word in the parser's input buffer, and keyword_len
gives its length; it is not null-terminated. The function is expected to examine the word, and possibly other state such as %^H, to decide whether it wants to handle it as an extended keyword. If it does not, the function should return KEYWORD_PLUGIN_DECLINE
, and the normal parser process will continue.
If the function wants to handle the keyword, it first must parse anything following the keyword that is part of the syntax introduced by the keyword. See "Lexer interface" for details.
When a keyword is being handled, the plugin function must build a tree of OP
structures, representing the code that was parsed. The root of the tree must be stored in *op_ptr
. The function then returns a constant indicating the syntactic role of the construct that it has parsed: KEYWORD_PLUGIN_STMT
if it is a complete statement, or KEYWORD_PLUGIN_EXPR
if it is an expression. Note that a statement construct cannot be used inside an expression (except via do BLOCK
and similar), and an expression is not a complete statement (it requires at least a terminating semicolon).
When a keyword is handled, the plugin function may also have (compile-time) side effects. It may modify %^H
, define functions, and so on. Typically, if side effects are the main purpose of a handler, it does not wish to generate any ops to be included in the normal compilation. In this case it is still required to supply an op tree, but it suffices to generate a single null op.
That's how the *PL_keyword_plugin
function needs to behave overall. Conventionally, however, one does not completely replace the existing handler function. Instead, take a copy of PL_keyword_plugin
before assigning your own function pointer to it. Your handler function should look for keywords that it is interested in and handle those. Where it is not interested, it should call the saved plugin function, passing on the arguments it received. Thus PL_keyword_plugin
actually points at a chain of handler functions, all of which have an opportunity to handle keywords, and only the last function in the chain (built into the Perl core) will normally return KEYWORD_PLUGIN_DECLINE
.
For thread safety, modules should not set this variable directly. Instead, use the function "wrap_keyword_plugin".
A GV is a structure which corresponds to to a Perl typeglob, ie *foo. It is a structure that holds a pointer to a scalar, an array, a hash etc, corresponding to $foo, @foo, %foo.
GVs are usually found as values in stashes (symbol table hashes) where Perl stores its global variables.
Return the AV from the GV.
AV* GvAV(GV* gv)
Implements use warnings 'once';
Recursively scan a stash (i.e. package) and any nested stashes looking for entries that need the "only used once" warning raised.
Names starting with "_" and names not starting with a valid identifier are not reported, and neither names with the MULTI flag.
void gv_check(HV* stash)
If gv
is a typeglob whose subroutine entry is a constant sub eligible for inlining, or gv
is a placeholder reference that would be promoted to such a typeglob, then returns the value returned by the sub. Otherwise, returns NULL
.
SV* gv_const_sv(GV* gv)
Return the CV from the GV.
CV* GvCV(GV* gv)
Like "gv_fetchmeth_pvn", but lacks a flags parameter.
GV* gv_fetchmeth(HV* stash, const char* name,
STRLEN len, I32 level)
Returns the glob which contains the subroutine to call to invoke the method on the stash
. In fact in the presence of autoloading this may be the glob for "AUTOLOAD". In this case the corresponding variable $AUTOLOAD
is already setup.
The third parameter of gv_fetchmethod_autoload
determines whether AUTOLOAD lookup is performed if the given method is not present: non-zero means yes, look for AUTOLOAD; zero means no, don't look for AUTOLOAD. Calling gv_fetchmethod
is equivalent to calling gv_fetchmethod_autoload
with a non-zero autoload
parameter.
These functions grant "SUPER"
token as a prefix of the method name. Note that if you want to keep the returned glob for a long time, you need to check for it being "AUTOLOAD"
, since at the later time the call may load a different subroutine due to $AUTOLOAD
changing its value. Use the glob created as a side effect to do this.
These functions have the same side-effects as gv_fetchmeth
with level==0
. The warning against passing the GV returned by gv_fetchmeth
to call_sv
applies equally to these functions.
XXX Note that restricted stashes are not supported yet, when the method does not exist. It will throw a wrong run-time error.
GV* gv_fetchmethod_autoload(HV* stash,
const char* name,
I32 autoload)
This is the old form of "gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload", which has no flags parameter.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_autoload(HV* stash,
const char* name,
STRLEN len, I32 level)
Exactly like "gv_fetchmeth_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pv(HV* stash, const char* name,
I32 level, U32 flags)
Returns the glob with the given name
and a defined subroutine or NULL
. The glob lives in the given stash
, or in the stashes accessible via @ISA
and UNIVERSAL::
.
The argument level
should be either 0 or -1. If level==0
, as a side-effect creates a glob with the given name
in the given stash
which in the case of success contains an alias for the subroutine, and sets up caching info for this glob.
The only significant values for flags
are GV_SUPER
, SVf_UTF8
, and GV_CLASS
.
GV_SUPER
indicates that we want to look up the method in the superclasses of the stash
.
GV_CLASS
allows for non-existing methods to be searched in classes or readonly packages. Normally a failing lookup will throw a restricted hash error.
The GV returned from gv_fetchmeth
may be a method cache entry, which is not visible to Perl code. So when calling call_sv
, you should not use the GV directly; instead, you should use the method's CV, which can be obtained from the GV with the GvCV
macro.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pvn(HV* stash, const char* name,
STRLEN len, I32 level,
U32 flags)
Same as gv_fetchmeth_pvn()
, but looks for autoloaded subroutines too. Returns a glob for the subroutine.
For an autoloaded subroutine without a GV, will create a GV even if level < 0
. For an autoloaded subroutine without a stub, GvCV()
of the result may be zero.
Currently, the only significant value for flags
is SVf_UTF8
.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload(HV* stash,
const char* name,
STRLEN len, I32 level,
U32 flags)
Exactly like "gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_pv_autoload(HV* stash,
const char* name,
I32 level, U32 flags)
Exactly like "gv_fetchmeth_pvn", but takes the name string in the form of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_sv(HV* stash, SV* namesv,
I32 level, U32 flags)
Exactly like "gv_fetchmeth_pvn_autoload", but takes the name string in the form of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
GV* gv_fetchmeth_sv_autoload(HV* stash, SV* namesv,
I32 level, U32 flags)
Return the HV from the GV.
HV* GvHV(GV* gv)
The old form of gv_init_pvn()
. It does not work with UTF-8 strings, as it has no flags parameter. If the multi
parameter is set, the GV_ADDMULTI
flag will be passed to gv_init_pvn()
.
void gv_init(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name,
STRLEN len, int multi)
Same as gv_init_pvn()
, but takes a nul-terminated string for the name instead of separate char * and length parameters.
void gv_init_pv(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name,
U32 flags)
Converts a scalar into a typeglob. This is an incoercible typeglob; assigning a reference to it will assign to one of its slots, instead of overwriting it as happens with typeglobs created by SvSetSV
. Converting any scalar that is SvOK()
may produce unpredictable results and is reserved for perl's internal use.
gv
is the scalar to be converted.
stash
is the parent stash/package, if any.
name
and len
give the name. The name must be unqualified; that is, it must not include the package name. If gv
is a stash element, it is the caller's responsibility to ensure that the name passed to this function matches the name of the element. If it does not match, perl's internal bookkeeping will get out of sync.
flags
can be set to SVf_UTF8
if name
is a UTF-8 string, or the return value of SvUTF8(sv). It can also take the GV_ADDMULTI
flag, which means to pretend that the GV has been seen before (i.e., suppress "Used once" warnings).
void gv_init_pvn(GV* gv, HV* stash, const char* name,
STRLEN len, U32 flags)
Same as gv_init_pvn()
, but takes an SV * for the name instead of separate char * and length parameters. flags
is currently unused.
void gv_init_sv(GV* gv, HV* stash, SV* namesv,
U32 flags)
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. Uses strlen
to determine the length of name
, then calls gv_stashpvn()
.
HV* gv_stashpv(const char* name, I32 flags)
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. The namelen
parameter indicates the length of the name
, in bytes. flags
is passed to gv_fetchpvn_flags()
, so if set to GV_ADD
then the package will be created if it does not already exist. If the package does not exist and flags
is 0 (or any other setting that does not create packages) then NULL
is returned.
Flags may be one of:
GV_ADD
SVf_UTF8
GV_NOADD_NOINIT
GV_NOINIT
GV_NOEXPAND
GV_ADDMG
GV_CACHE_ONLY
GV_NO_SVGMAGIC
GV_CLASS
The most important of which are probably GV_ADD
and SVf_UTF8
.
Note, use of gv_stashsv
instead of gv_stashpvn
where possible is strongly recommended for performance reasons.
HV* gv_stashpvn(const char* name, U32 namelen,
I32 flags)
Like gv_stashpvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
HV* gv_stashpvs("literal string" name, I32 create)
Returns a pointer to the stash for a specified package. See "gv_stashpvn"
.
Note this interface is strongly preferred over gv_stashpvn
for performance reasons.
HV* gv_stashsv(SV* sv, I32 flags)
Return the SV from the GV.
SV* GvSV(GV* gv)
Sets PL_defoutgv
, the default file handle for output, to the passed in typeglob. As PL_defoutgv
"owns" a reference on its typeglob, the reference count of the passed in typeglob is increased by one, and the reference count of the typeglob that PL_defoutgv
points to is decreased by one.
void setdefout(GV* gv)
Null AV pointer.
(deprecated - use (AV *)NULL
instead)
Null character pointer. (No longer available when PERL_CORE
is defined.)
Null CV pointer.
(deprecated - use (CV *)NULL
instead)
Null HV pointer.
(deprecated - use (HV *)NULL
instead)
Null SV pointer. (No longer available when PERL_CORE
is defined.)
Array accessor.
SV** HvARRAY(HV *hv)
An extra hash struct available if "SvOOK" is true. This quite intentionally does no SvOOK
flag checking. That's your responsibility.
struct xpvhv_aux* HvAUX(HV *hv)
If the stash is a class.
bool HvCLASS(HV *stash)
Turns the stash into a class.
void HvCLASS_on(HV *stash)
Writable access to the eiter field in HvAUX.
U32* HvEITER(HV *hv)
Returns the "HvEITER" or NULL
U32* HvEITER_get(HV *hv)
Access to "hv_eiter_set"
void HvEITER_set(HV *hv, U32 eiter)
Returns the effective name of a stash, or NULL if there is none. The effective name represents a location in the symbol table where this stash resides. It is updated automatically when packages are aliased or deleted. A stash that is no longer in the symbol table has no effective name. This name is preferable to HvNAME
for use in MRO linearisations and isa caches.
char* HvENAME(HV* stash)
Returns the length of the stash's effective name.
I32 HvENAMELEN(HV *stash)
Returns true if the effective name is in UTF-8 encoding.
unsigned char HvENAMEUTF8(HV *stash)
Returns the writable fields buffer for a class, which needs to exist.
char* HvFIELDS(HV *klass)
Returns the fields buffer for a class or NULL.
char* HvFIELDS_get(HV *klass)
Accessor to "hv_fill"
U32 HvFILL(HV *hv)
Returns the hash specific flags from HvAUX.
U32 HvFLAGS(HV *hv)
Returns the value of xhv_last_rand or 0.
With PERL_HASH_RANDOMIZE_KEYS (i.e. not in cperl) the last random value for hash traversal, used to detect each() after insert for warnings.
U32 HvLASTRAND_get(HV *hv)
Size of "HvARRAY"
U32 HvMAX(HV *hv)
Returns the package name of a stash, or NULL
if stash
isn't a stash. See "SvSTASH"
, "CvSTASH"
.
char* HvNAME(HV* stash)
Returns the length of the stash's name.
I32 HvNAMELEN(HV *stash)
Returns true if the name is in UTF-8 encoding.
unsigned char HvNAMEUTF8(HV *stash)
Returns either "package", "role" or "class"
const char* HvPKGTYPE(HV *stash)
Returns "HvPKGTYPE" for an existing stash.
const char* HvPKGTYPE_NN(HV *stash)
Returns the value of xhv_rand or 0
With PERL_HASH_RANDOMIZE_KEYS (i.e. not in cperl) the random value for hash traversal.
U32 HvRAND_get(HV *hv)
Writable access to the riter field in HvAUX.
U32 HvRITER(HV *hv)
Returns the "HvRITER" or the HV_NO_RITER
value if HvAUX does not exist.
U32 HvRITER_get(HV *hv)
Access to "hv_riter_set"
void HvRITER_set(HV *hv, U32 riter)
If the stash is a role.
bool HvROLE(HV *stash)
Turns the stash into a role.
void HvROLE_on(HV *stash)
Returns !0 if the HvAUXf_STATIC flag is set, when the hash buffer are statically allocated (only with embedder or in the compiler). Is usually combined with SvREADONLY.
bool HvSTATIC(HV *hv)
This flag, used in the length slot of hash entries and magic structures, specifies the structure contains an SV*
pointer where a char*
pointer is to be expected. (For information only--not to be used).
Returns the computed hash stored in the hash entry.
U32 HeHASH(HE* he)
Returns the actual pointer stored in the key slot of the hash entry. The pointer may be either char*
or SV*
, depending on the value of HeKLEN()
. Can be assigned to. The HePV()
or HeSVKEY()
macros are usually preferable for finding the value of a key.
void* HeKEY(HE* he)
If this is negative, and amounts to HEf_SVKEY
, it indicates the entry holds an SV*
key. Otherwise, holds the actual length of the key. Can be assigned to. The HePV()
macro is usually preferable for finding key lengths.
I32 HeKLEN(HE* he)
Returns the key slot of the hash entry as a char*
value, doing any necessary dereferencing of possibly SV*
keys. The length of the string is placed in len
(this is a macro, so do not use &len
). If you do not care about what the length of the key is, you may use the global variable PL_na
, though this is rather less efficient than using a local variable. Remember though, that hash keys in perl are free to contain embedded nulls, so using strlen()
or similar is not a good way to find the length of hash keys. This is very similar to the SvPV()
macro described elsewhere in this document. See also "HeUTF8"
. Note also that the hash key length cannot be longer than 31bit, even if it is a HEf_SVKEY
.
If you are using HePV
to get values to pass to newSVpvn()
to create a new SV, you should consider using newSVhek(HeKEY_hek(he))
as it is more efficient.
char* HePV(HE* he, STRLEN len)
Returns the key as an SV*
, or NULL
if the hash entry does not contain an SV*
key.
SV* HeSVKEY(HE* he)
Returns the key as an SV*
. Will create and return a temporary mortal SV*
if the hash entry contains only a char*
key.
SV* HeSVKEY_force(HE* he)
Sets the key to a given SV*
, taking care to set the appropriate flags to indicate the presence of an SV*
key, and returns the same SV*
.
SV* HeSVKEY_set(HE* he, SV* sv)
Returns whether the char *
value returned by HePV
is encoded in UTF-8, doing any necessary dereferencing of possibly SV*
keys. The value returned will be 0 or non-0, not necessarily 1 (or even a value with any low bits set), so do not blindly assign this to a bool
variable, as bool
may be a typedef for char
.
U32 HeUTF8(HE* he)
Returns the value slot (type SV*
) stored in the hash entry. Can be assigned to.
SV *foo= HeVAL(hv);
HeVAL(hv)= sv;
SV* HeVAL(HE* he)
Creates a new HV. The reference count is set to 1.
HV* newHV()
A HV structure represents a Perl hash. It consists mainly of an array of pointers, each of which points to a linked list of HE structures. The array is indexed by the hash function of the key, so each linked list represents all the hash entries with the same hash value. Each HE contains a pointer to the actual value, plus a pointer to a HEK structure which holds the key and hash value.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Returns the label attached to a cop. The flags pointer may be set to SVf_UTF8
or 0.
const char * cop_fetch_label(COP *const cop,
STRLEN *len, U32 *flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Save a label into a cop_hints_hash
. You need to set flags to SVf_UTF8
for a UTF-8 label.
void cop_store_label(COP *const cop,
const char *label, STRLEN len,
U32 flags)
Uses strlen
to get the length of name
, then calls get_hvn_flags
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
HV* get_hv(const char *name, I32 flags)
Returns the HV of the specified Perl hash. flags
are passed to gv_fetchpv
. If GV_ADD
is set and the Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If flags
is zero and the variable does not exist then NULL
is returned.
In cperl only.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
HV* get_hvn_flags(const char* name, STRLEN len,
I32 flags)
get_hvs("Name", flags)
to be used with a constant string.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
HV* get_hvs(const char *name, I32 flags)
Check that a hash is in an internally consistent state.
void hv_assert(HV *hv)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
If the hash is tied dispatches through to the SCALAR tied method, otherwise if the hash contains no keys returns 0, otherwise returns a mortal sv containing a string specifying the number of used buckets, followed by a slash, followed by the number of available buckets.
This function is expensive, it must scan all of the buckets to determine which are used, and the count is NOT cached. In a large hash this could be a lot of buckets.
SV* hv_bucket_ratio(HV *hv)
Frees the all the elements of a hash, leaving it empty. The XS equivalent of %hash = ()
. See also "hv_undef".
See "av_clear" for a note about the hash possibly being invalid on return.
void hv_clear(HV *hv)
Clears any placeholders from a hash. If a restricted hash has any of its keys marked as readonly and the key is subsequently deleted, the key is not actually deleted but is marked by assigning it a value of PLACEHOLDER
. This tags it so it will be ignored by future operations such as iterating over the hash, but will still allow the hash to have a value reassigned to the key at some future point. This function clears any such placeholder keys from the hash. See Hash::Util::lock_keys()
for an example of its use.
void hv_clear_placeholders(HV *hv)
A specialised version of "newHVhv" for copying %^H
. ohv
must be a pointer to a hash (which may have %^H
magic, but should be generally non-magical), or NULL
(interpreted as an empty hash). The content of ohv
is copied to a new hash, which has the %^H
-specific magic added to it. A pointer to the new hash is returned.
HV * hv_copy_hints_hv(HV *ohv)
Deletes a key/value pair in the hash. The value's SV is removed from the hash, made mortal, and returned to the caller. The absolute value of klen
is the length of the key. If klen
is negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. The flags
value will normally be zero; if set to G_DISCARD
then NULL
will be returned. NULL
will also be returned if the key is not found.
SV* hv_delete(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen,
I32 flags)
Deletes a key/value pair in the hash. The value SV is removed from the hash, made mortal, and returned to the caller. The flags
value will normally be zero; if set to G_DISCARD
then NULL
will be returned. NULL
will also be returned if the key is not found. hash
can be a valid precomputed hash value, or 0 to ask for it to be computed.
SV* hv_delete_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, I32 flags,
U32 hash)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified hash key exists. The absolute value of klen
is the length of the key. If klen
is negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode.
bool hv_exists(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the specified hash key exists. hash
can be a valid precomputed hash value, or 0 to ask for it to be computed.
bool hv_exists_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, U32 hash)
Returns the SV which corresponds to the specified key in the hash. The absolute value of klen
is the length of the key. If klen
is negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. If lval
is set then the fetch will be part of a store. This means that if there is no value in the hash associated with the given key, then one is created and a pointer to it is returned. The SV*
it points to can be assigned to. But always check that the return value is non-null before dereferencing it to an SV*
.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
SV** hv_fetch(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen,
I32 lval)
Like hv_fetch
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
SV** hv_fetchs(HV* tb, "literal string" key,
I32 lval)
Returns the hash entry which corresponds to the specified key in the hash. hash
must be a valid precomputed hash number for the given key
, or 0 if you want the function to compute it. IF lval
is set then the fetch will be part of a store. Make sure the return value is non-null before accessing it. The return value when hv
is a tied hash is a pointer to a static location, so be sure to make a copy of the structure if you need to store it somewhere.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
HE* hv_fetch_ent(HV *hv, SV *keysv, I32 lval,
U32 hash)
Returns the number of hash buckets that happen to be in use.
This function is wrapped by the macro HvFILL
.
Since perl 5.25 this function is used only for debugging purposes, and the number of used hash buckets is not in any way cached, thus this function can be costly to execute as it must iterate over all the buckets in the hash.
U32 hv_fill(HV *const hv)
Prepares a starting point to traverse a hash table. Returns the number of keys in the hash, including placeholders (i.e. the same as HvTOTALKEYS(hv)
). The return value is currently only meaningful for hashes without tie magic.
NOTE: Before version 5.004_65, hv_iterinit
used to return the number of hash buckets that happen to be in use. If you still need that esoteric value, you can get it through the macro HvFILL(hv)
.
U32 hv_iterinit(HV *hv)
Returns the key from the current position of the hash iterator. See "hv_iterinit"
.
char* hv_iterkey(HE* entry, I32* retlen)
Returns the key as an SV*
from the current position of the hash iterator. The return value will always be a mortal copy of the key. Also see "hv_iterinit"
.
SV* hv_iterkeysv(HE* entry)
Returns entries from a hash iterator. See "hv_iterinit"
.
You may call hv_delete
or hv_delete_ent
on the hash entry that the iterator currently points to, without losing your place or invalidating your iterator. Note that in this case the current entry is deleted from the hash with your iterator holding the last reference to it. Your iterator is flagged to free the entry on the next call to hv_iternext
, so you must not discard your iterator immediately else the entry will leak - call hv_iternext
to trigger the resource deallocation.
HE* hv_iternext(HV *hv)
Performs an hv_iternext
, hv_iterkey
, and hv_iterval
in one operation.
SV* hv_iternextsv(HV *hv, char **key, I32 *retlen)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Returns entries from a hash iterator. See "hv_iterinit"
and "hv_iternext"
. The flags
value will normally be zero; if HV_ITERNEXT_WANTPLACEHOLDERS
is set the placeholders keys (for restricted hashes) will be returned in addition to normal keys. By default placeholders are automatically skipped over. Currently a placeholder is implemented with a value that is PLACEHOLDER
. Note that the implementation of placeholders and restricted hashes may change, and the implementation currently is insufficiently abstracted for any change to be tidy.
HE* hv_iternext_flags(HV *hv, I32 flags)
Returns the value from the current position of the hash iterator. See "hv_iterkey"
.
SV* hv_iterval(HV *hv, HE *entry)
Adds magic to a hash. See "sv_magic".
void hv_magic(HV *hv, GV *gv, int how)
Returns the count of hash placeholders, deleted elements. Used as HvPLACEHOLDERS_get(hv)
U32 hv_placeholders_get(const HV *hv)
Sets the count of hash placeholders, deleted elements. Used as HvPLACEHOLDERS_set(hv, 0)
void hv_placeholders_set(HV *hv, U32 ph)
Evaluates the hash in scalar context and returns the result.
When the hash is tied dispatches through to the SCALAR method, otherwise returns a mortal SV containing the number of keys in the hash.
Note, prior to 5.25 this function returned what is now returned by the hv_bucket_ratio() function.
SV* hv_scalar(HV *hv)
Stores an SV in a hash. The hash key is specified as key
and the absolute value of klen
is the length of the key. If klen
is negative the key is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode. The hash
parameter is the precomputed hash value; if it is zero then Perl will compute it.
The return value will be NULL
if the operation failed or if the value did not need to be actually stored within the hash (as in the case of tied hashes). Otherwise it can be dereferenced to get the original SV*
. Note that the caller is responsible for suitably incrementing the reference count of val
before the call, and decrementing it if the function returned NULL
. Effectively a successful hv_store
takes ownership of one reference to val
. This is usually what you want; a newly created SV has a reference count of one, so if all your code does is create SVs then store them in a hash, hv_store
will own the only reference to the new SV, and your code doesn't need to do anything further to tidy up. hv_store
is not implemented as a call to hv_store_ent
, and does not create a temporary SV for the key, so if your key data is not already in SV form then use hv_store
in preference to hv_store_ent
.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
SV** hv_store(HV *hv, const char *key, I32 klen,
SV *val, U32 hash)
Like hv_store
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair and omits the hash parameter.
SV** hv_stores(HV* tb, "literal string" key,
NULLOK SV* val)
Stores val
in a hash. The hash key is specified as key
. The hash
parameter is the precomputed hash value; if it is zero then Perl will compute it. The return value is the new hash entry so created. It will be NULL
if the operation failed or if the value did not need to be actually stored within the hash (as in the case of tied hashes). Otherwise the contents of the return value can be accessed using the He?
macros described here. Note that the caller is responsible for suitably incrementing the reference count of val
before the call, and decrementing it if the function returned NULL. Effectively a successful hv_store_ent
takes ownership of one reference to val
. This is usually what you want; a newly created SV has a reference count of one, so if all your code does is create SVs then store them in a hash, hv_store
will own the only reference to the new SV, and your code doesn't need to do anything further to tidy up. Note that hv_store_ent
only reads the key
; unlike val
it does not take ownership of it, so maintaining the correct reference count on key
is entirely the caller's responsibility. The reason it does not take ownership, is that key
is not used after this function returns, and so can be freed immediately. hv_store
is not implemented as a call to hv_store_ent
, and does not create a temporary SV for the key, so if your key data is not already in SV form then use hv_store
in preference to hv_store_ent
.
See "Understanding the Magic of Tied Hashes and Arrays" in perlguts for more information on how to use this function on tied hashes.
HE* hv_store_ent(HV *hv, SV *key, SV *val, U32 hash)
Optimizes the internal structure of a hash. Clears placeholders, shrinks it, and later for a readonly hash possibly re-arrange to a perfect hash.
void hv_study(HV *hv)
Undefines the hash. The XS equivalent of undef(%hash)
.
As well as freeing all the elements of the hash (like "hv_clear"), this also frees any auxiliary data and storage associated with the hash.
See "av_clear" for a note about the hash possibly being invalid on return.
void hv_undef(HV *hv)
Adds the HV_NAME_SETALL
flag optionally to "hv_undef", which is needed when being called from "sv_clear". Then we must check for effective names that need freeing, as well as the usual name.
void hv_undef_flags(HV *hv, U32 flags)
get a (constant) string ptr from the global string table.
string will get added if it is not already there. len and hash must both be valid for str. A negative len denotes utf8, which is then tried to be downgraded.
The shared hek has a he entry before in memory, and the HEK_KEY can be used as a SvPVX entry. It needs IsCOW and LEN=0 then. See "newSVpvn_share" in perlapi.
HEK* share_hek(const char* str, I32 len, U32 hash)
possibly free a shared hek if no one has access to it.
void unshare_hek(const HEK* hek)
possibly free a shared string if no one has access to it. len and hash must both be valid for str.
void unsharepvn(const char* sv, I32 len, U32 hash)
These functions provide convenient and thread-safe means of manipulating hook variables.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Extend a parsed package block to a class or role, and add its ISA and DOES arrays. They are closed by default.
:native is parsed as repr(CStruct). This needs a HvAUX flag as well.
Warn on existing packages.
void class_role(OP* o)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Create the field accessors and resolve internal lexicals to fields in all methods. Apply fields optimizations and type checks. Close the class/role.
Note that we need to undo the stash restricted'ness during destruction.
void class_role_finalize(OP* o)
Try to detect if the method_named call is a method call on an object class field. $self, the object target needs to be typed to a class.
Returns the field type: 1 - scalar 2 - array 3 - hash or 0 if none. int method_field_type(OP* o)
|Perl_check_t new_checker|Perl_check_t *old_checker_p
Puts a C function into the chain of check functions for a specified op type. This is the preferred way to manipulate the "PL_check" array. opcode
specifies which type of op is to be affected. new_checker
is a pointer to the C function that is to be added to that opcode's check chain, and old_checker_p
points to the storage location where a pointer to the next function in the chain will be stored. The value of new_checker
is written into the "PL_check" array, while the value previously stored there is written to *old_checker_p
.
"PL_check" is global to an entire process, and a module wishing to hook op checking may find itself invoked more than once per process, typically in different threads. To handle that situation, this function is idempotent. The location *old_checker_p
must initially (once per process) contain a null pointer. A C variable of static duration (declared at file scope, typically also marked static
to give it internal linkage) will be implicitly initialised appropriately, if it does not have an explicit initialiser. This function will only actually modify the check chain if it finds *old_checker_p
to be null. This function is also thread safe on the small scale. It uses appropriate locking to avoid race conditions in accessing "PL_check".
When this function is called, the function referenced by new_checker
must be ready to be called, except for *old_checker_p
being unfilled. In a threading situation, new_checker
may be called immediately, even before this function has returned. *old_checker_p
will always be appropriately set before new_checker
is called. If new_checker
decides not to do anything special with an op that it is given (which is the usual case for most uses of op check hooking), it must chain the check function referenced by *old_checker_p
.
Taken all together, XS code to hook an op checker should typically look something like this:
static Perl_check_t nxck_frob;
static OP *myck_frob(pTHX_ OP *op) {
...
op = nxck_frob(aTHX_ op);
...
return op;
}
BOOT:
wrap_op_checker(OP_FROB, myck_frob, &nxck_frob);
If you want to influence compilation of calls to a specific subroutine, then use "cv_set_call_checker_flags" rather than hooking checking of all entersub
ops.
void wrap_op_checker(Optype opcode \)
This is the lower layer of the Perl parser, managing characters and tokens.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Indicates whether the octets in the lexer buffer ("PL_parser->linestr") should be interpreted as the UTF-8 encoding of Unicode characters. If not, they should be interpreted as Latin-1 characters. This is analogous to the SvUTF8
flag for scalars.
In UTF-8 mode, it is not guaranteed that the lexer buffer actually contains valid UTF-8. Lexing code must be robust in the face of invalid encoding.
The actual SvUTF8
flag of the "PL_parser->linestr" scalar is significant, but not the whole story regarding the input character encoding. Normally, when a file is being read, the scalar contains octets and its SvUTF8
flag is off, but the octets should be interpreted as UTF-8 if the use utf8
pragma is in effect. During a string eval, however, the scalar may have the SvUTF8
flag on, and in this case its octets should be interpreted as UTF-8 unless the use bytes
pragma is in effect. This logic may change in the future; use this function instead of implementing the logic yourself.
bool lex_bufutf8()
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Discards the first part of the "PL_parser->linestr" buffer, up to ptr
. The remaining content of the buffer will be moved, and all pointers into the buffer updated appropriately. ptr
must not be later in the buffer than the position of "PL_parser->bufptr": it is not permitted to discard text that has yet to be lexed.
Normally it is not necessarily to do this directly, because it suffices to use the implicit discarding behaviour of "lex_next_chunk" and things based on it. However, if a token stretches across multiple lines, and the lexing code has kept multiple lines of text in the buffer for that purpose, then after completion of the token it would be wise to explicitly discard the now-unneeded earlier lines, to avoid future multi-line tokens growing the buffer without bound.
void lex_discard_to(char *ptr)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Reallocates the lexer buffer ("PL_parser->linestr") to accommodate at least len
octets (including terminating NUL
). Returns a pointer to the reallocated buffer. This is necessary before making any direct modification of the buffer that would increase its length. "lex_stuff_pvn" provides a more convenient way to insert text into the buffer.
Do not use SvGROW
or sv_grow
directly on PL_parser->linestr
; this function updates all of the lexer's variables that point directly into the buffer.
char * lex_grow_linestr(STRLEN len)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Reads in the next chunk of text to be lexed, appending it to "PL_parser->linestr". This should be called when lexing code has looked to the end of the current chunk and wants to know more. It is usual, but not necessary, for lexing to have consumed the entirety of the current chunk at this time.
If "PL_parser->bufptr" is pointing to the very end of the current chunk (i.e., the current chunk has been entirely consumed), normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time that the new chunk is read in. If flags
has the LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS
bit set, the current chunk will not be discarded. If the current chunk has not been entirely consumed, then it will not be discarded regardless of the flag.
Returns true if some new text was added to the buffer, or false if the buffer has reached the end of the input text.
bool lex_next_chunk(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Looks ahead one (Unicode) character in the text currently being lexed. Returns the codepoint (unsigned integer value) of the next character, or -1 if lexing has reached the end of the input text. To consume the peeked character, use "lex_read_unichar".
If the next character is in (or extends into) the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags
has the LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS
bit set, then the current chunk will not be discarded.
If the input is being interpreted as UTF-8 and a UTF-8 encoding error is encountered, an exception is generated.
I32 lex_peek_unichar(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Reads optional spaces, in Perl style, in the text currently being lexed. The spaces may include ordinary whitespace characters and Perl-style comments. #line
directives are processed if encountered. "PL_parser->bufptr" is moved past the spaces, so that it points at a non-space character (or the end of the input text).
If spaces extend into the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags
has the LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS
bit set, then the current chunk will not be discarded.
void lex_read_space(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Consume text in the lexer buffer, from "PL_parser->bufptr" up to ptr
. This advances "PL_parser->bufptr" to match ptr
, performing the correct bookkeeping whenever a newline character is passed. This is the normal way to consume lexed text.
Interpretation of the buffer's octets can be abstracted out by using the slightly higher-level functions "lex_peek_unichar" and "lex_read_unichar".
void lex_read_to(char *ptr)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Reads the next (Unicode) character in the text currently being lexed. Returns the codepoint (unsigned integer value) of the character read, and moves "PL_parser->bufptr" past the character, or returns -1 if lexing has reached the end of the input text. To non-destructively examine the next character, use "lex_peek_unichar" instead.
If the next character is in (or extends into) the next chunk of input text, the next chunk will be read in. Normally the current chunk will be discarded at the same time, but if flags
has the LEX_KEEP_PREVIOUS
bit set, then the current chunk will not be discarded.
If the input is being interpreted as UTF-8 and a UTF-8 encoding error is encountered, an exception is generated.
I32 lex_read_unichar(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Creates and initialises a new lexer/parser state object, supplying a context in which to lex and parse from a new source of Perl code. A pointer to the new state object is placed in "PL_parser". An entry is made on the save stack so that upon unwinding, the new state object will be destroyed and the former value of "PL_parser" will be restored. Nothing else need be done to clean up the parsing context.
The code to be parsed comes from line
and rsfp
. line
, if non-null, provides a string (in SV form) containing code to be parsed. A copy of the string is made, so subsequent modification of line
does not affect parsing. rsfp
, if non-null, provides an input stream from which code will be read to be parsed. If both are non-null, the code in line
comes first and must consist of complete lines of input, and rsfp
supplies the remainder of the source.
The flags
parameter is reserved for future use. Currently it is only used by perl internally, so extensions should always pass zero.
LEX_START_SAME_FILTER indicates that this is not a new file, so it can share filters with the current parser.
LEX_START_DONT_CLOSE indicates that the file handle wasn't opened by the caller, hence isn't owned by the parser, so shouldn't be closed on parser destruction. This is used to handle the case of defaulting to reading the script from the standard input because no filename was given on the command line (without getting confused by situation where STDIN has been closed, so the script handle is opened on fd 0)
void lex_start(SV *line, PerlIO *rsfp, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer ("PL_parser->linestr"), immediately after the current lexing point ("PL_parser->bufptr"), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is represented by octets starting at pv
and continuing to the first nul. These octets are interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, according to whether the LEX_STUFF_UTF8
flag is set in flags
. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted ("lex_bufutf8"). If it is not convenient to nul-terminate a string to be inserted, the "lex_stuff_pvn" function is more appropriate.
void lex_stuff_pv(const char *pv, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer ("PL_parser->linestr"), immediately after the current lexing point ("PL_parser->bufptr"), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is represented by len
octets starting at pv
. These octets are interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, according to whether the LEX_STUFF_UTF8
flag is set in flags
. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted ("lex_bufutf8"). If a string to be inserted is available as a Perl scalar, the "lex_stuff_sv" function is more convenient.
void lex_stuff_pvn(const char *pv, STRLEN len,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Like "lex_stuff_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void lex_stuff_pvs("literal string" pv, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Insert characters into the lexer buffer ("PL_parser->linestr"), immediately after the current lexing point ("PL_parser->bufptr"), reallocating the buffer if necessary. This means that lexing code that runs later will see the characters as if they had appeared in the input. It is not recommended to do this as part of normal parsing, and most uses of this facility run the risk of the inserted characters being interpreted in an unintended manner.
The string to be inserted is the string value of sv
. The characters are recoded for the lexer buffer, according to how the buffer is currently being interpreted ("lex_bufutf8"). If a string to be inserted is not already a Perl scalar, the "lex_stuff_pvn" function avoids the need to construct a scalar.
void lex_stuff_sv(SV *sv, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Discards text about to be lexed, from "PL_parser->bufptr" up to ptr
. Text following ptr
will be moved, and the buffer shortened. This hides the discarded text from any lexing code that runs later, as if the text had never appeared.
This is not the normal way to consume lexed text. For that, use "lex_read_to".
void lex_unstuff(char *ptr)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a Perl arithmetic expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the bit shift operators. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a comparison or lower-precedence operator or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags
has the PARSE_OPTIONAL
bit set, then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_arithexpr(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a single unadorned Perl statement. This may be a normal imperative statement or a declaration that has compile-time effect. It does not include any label or other affixture. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the statement is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statement is null, for example if it was actually a subroutine definition (which has compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be ops directly implementing the statement, suitable to pass to "newSTATEOP". It will not normally include a nextstate
or equivalent op (except for those embedded in a scope contained entirely within the statement).
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags
parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_barestmt(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl code block. This consists of an opening brace, a sequence of statements, and a closing brace. The block constitutes a lexical scope, so my
variables and various compile-time effects can be contained within it. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the code block is returned. This is always a real op, never a null pointer. It will normally be a lineseq
list, including nextstate
or equivalent ops. No ops to construct any kind of runtime scope are included by virtue of it being a block.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags
parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_block(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl expression. This allows the full expression grammar, including the lowest-precedence operators such as or
. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) by a token that an expression would normally be terminated by: end-of-file, closing bracketing punctuation, semicolon, or one of the keywords that signals a postfix expression-statement modifier. If flags
has the PARSE_OPTIONAL
bit set, then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_fullexpr(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a single complete Perl statement. This may be a normal imperative statement or a declaration that has compile-time effect, and may include optional labels. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statement.
The op tree representing the statement is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statement is null, for example if it was actually a subroutine definition (which has compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be the result of a "newSTATEOP" call, normally including a nextstate
or equivalent op.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree (most likely null) is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags
parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_fullstmt(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a single label, possibly optional, of the type that may prefix a Perl statement. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed. If flags
has the PARSE_OPTIONAL
bit set, then the label is optional, otherwise it is mandatory.
The name of the label is returned in the form of a fresh scalar. If an optional label is absent, a null pointer is returned.
If an error occurs in parsing, which can only occur if the label is mandatory, a valid label is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred.
SV * parse_label(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a Perl list expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the comma operator. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a low-precedence logic operator such as or
or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags
has the PARSE_OPTIONAL
bit set, then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_listexpr(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a sequence of zero or more Perl statements. These may be normal imperative statements, including optional labels, or declarations that have compile-time effect, or any mixture thereof. The statement sequence ends when a closing brace or end-of-file is encountered in a place where a new statement could have validly started. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the statements.
The op tree representing the statement sequence is returned. This may be a null pointer if the statements were all null, for example if there were no statements or if there were only subroutine definitions (which have compile-time side effects). If not null, it will be a lineseq
list, normally including nextstate
or equivalent ops.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
The flags
parameter is reserved for future use, and must always be zero.
OP * parse_stmtseq(U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Parse a Perl term expression. This may contain operators of precedence down to the assignment operators. The expression must be followed (and thus terminated) either by a comma or lower-precedence operator or by something that would normally terminate an expression such as semicolon. If flags
has the PARSE_OPTIONAL
bit set, then the expression is optional, otherwise it is mandatory. It is up to the caller to ensure that the dynamic parser state ("PL_parser" et al) is correctly set to reflect the source of the code to be parsed and the lexical context for the expression.
The op tree representing the expression is returned. If an optional expression is absent, a null pointer is returned, otherwise the pointer will be non-null.
If an error occurs in parsing or compilation, in most cases a valid op tree is returned anyway. The error is reflected in the parser state, normally resulting in a single exception at the top level of parsing which covers all the compilation errors that occurred. Some compilation errors, however, will throw an exception immediately.
OP * parse_termexpr(U32 flags)
Pointer to a structure encapsulating the state of the parsing operation currently in progress. The pointer can be locally changed to perform a nested parse without interfering with the state of an outer parse. Individual members of PL_parser
have their own documentation.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Direct pointer to the end of the chunk of text currently being lexed, the end of the lexer buffer. This is equal to SvPVX(PL_parser->linestr) + SvCUR(PL_parser->linestr)
. A NUL
character (zero octet) is always located at the end of the buffer, and does not count as part of the buffer's contents.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Points to the current position of lexing inside the lexer buffer. Characters around this point may be freely examined, within the range delimited by SvPVX("PL_parser->linestr")
and "PL_parser->bufend". The octets of the buffer may be intended to be interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1, as indicated by "lex_bufutf8".
Lexing code (whether in the Perl core or not) moves this pointer past the characters that it consumes. It is also expected to perform some bookkeeping whenever a newline character is consumed. This movement can be more conveniently performed by the function "lex_read_to", which handles newlines appropriately.
Interpretation of the buffer's octets can be abstracted out by using the slightly higher-level functions "lex_peek_unichar" and "lex_read_unichar".
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Points to the start of the current line inside the lexer buffer. This is useful for indicating at which column an error occurred, and not much else. This must be updated by any lexing code that consumes a newline; the function "lex_read_to" handles this detail.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Buffer scalar containing the chunk currently under consideration of the text currently being lexed. This is always a plain string scalar (for which SvPOK
is true). It is not intended to be used as a scalar by normal scalar means; instead refer to the buffer directly by the pointer variables described below.
The lexer maintains various char*
pointers to things in the PL_parser->linestr
buffer. If PL_parser->linestr
is ever reallocated, all of these pointers must be updated. Don't attempt to do this manually, but rather use "lex_grow_linestr" if you need to reallocate the buffer.
The content of the text chunk in the buffer is commonly exactly one complete line of input, up to and including a newline terminator, but there are situations where it is otherwise. The octets of the buffer may be intended to be interpreted as either UTF-8 or Latin-1. The function "lex_bufutf8" tells you which. Do not use the SvUTF8
flag on this scalar, which may disagree with it.
For direct examination of the buffer, the variable "PL_parser->bufend" points to the end of the buffer. The current lexing position is pointed to by "PL_parser->bufptr". Direct use of these pointers is usually preferable to examination of the scalar through normal scalar means.
cperl guarantees that the size of the buffer is minimal the PTRSIZE so we can use faster word-comparisons for longer strings, perl5 not.
takes: pointer to position in buffer
returns: pointer to new position in buffer
side-effects: builds ops for the constant in pl_yylval.op
Read a number in any of the formats that Perl accepts:
\d(_?\d)*(\.(\d(_?\d)*)?)?[Ee][\+\-]?(\d(_?\d)*) 12 12.34 12.
\.\d(_?\d)*[Ee][\+\-]?(\d(_?\d)*) .34
0b[01](_?[01])* binary integers
0[0-7](_?[0-7])* octal integers
0x[0-9A-Fa-f](_?[0-9A-Fa-f])* hexadecimal integers
0x[0-9A-Fa-f](_?[0-9A-Fa-f])*(?:\.\d*)?p[+-]?[0-9]+ hexadecimal floats
Like most scan_ routines, it uses the PL_tokenbuf buffer to hold the thing it reads.
If it reads a number without a decimal point or an exponent, it will try converting the number to an integer and see if it can do so without loss of precision.
char* scan_num(const char* s, YYSTYPE *lvalp)
Returns a pointer to the next character after the parsed vstring, as well as updating the passed in sv.
Function must be called like
sv = sv_2mortal(newSV(5));
s = scan_vstring(s,e,sv);
where s and e are the start and end of the string. The sv should already be large enough to store the vstring passed in, for performance reasons.
This function may croak if fatal warnings are enabled in the calling scope, hence the sv_2mortal in the example (to prevent a leak). Make sure to do SvREFCNT_inc afterwards if you use sv_2mortal.
char* scan_vstring(const char *s, const char *const e,
SV *sv)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Puts a C function into the chain of keyword plugins. This is the preferred way to manipulate the "PL_keyword_plugin" variable. new_plugin
is a pointer to the C function that is to be added to the keyword plugin chain, and old_plugin_p
points to the storage location where a pointer to the next function in the chain will be stored. The value of new_plugin
is written into the "PL_keyword_plugin" variable, while the value previously stored there is written to *old_plugin_p
.
"PL_keyword_plugin" is global to an entire process, and a module wishing to hook keyword parsing may find itself invoked more than once per process, typically in different threads. To handle that situation, this function is idempotent. The location *old_plugin_p
must initially (once per process) contain a null pointer. A C variable of static duration (declared at file scope, typically also marked static
to give it internal linkage) will be implicitly initialised appropriately, if it does not have an explicit initialiser. This function will only actually modify the plugin chain if it finds *old_plugin_p
to be null. This function is also thread safe on the small scale. It uses appropriate locking to avoid race conditions in accessing "PL_keyword_plugin".
When this function is called, the function referenced by new_plugin
must be ready to be called, except for *old_plugin_p
being unfilled. In a threading situation, new_plugin
may be called immediately, even before this function has returned. *old_plugin_p
will always be appropriately set before new_plugin
is called. If new_plugin
decides not to do anything special with the identifier that it is given (which is the usual case for most calls to a keyword plugin), it must chain the plugin function referenced by *old_plugin_p
.
Taken all together, XS code to install a keyword plugin should typically look something like this:
static Perl_keyword_plugin_t next_keyword_plugin;
static OP *my_keyword_plugin(pTHX_
char *keyword_plugin, STRLEN keyword_len, OP **op_ptr)
{
if (memEQs(keyword_ptr, keyword_len,
"my_new_keyword")) {
...
} else {
return next_keyword_plugin(aTHX_
keyword_ptr, keyword_len, op_ptr);
}
}
BOOT:
wrap_keyword_plugin(my_keyword_plugin,
&next_keyword_plugin);
Direct access to "PL_keyword_plugin" should be avoided.
void wrap_keyword_plugin(
Perl_keyword_plugin_t new_plugin,
Perl_keyword_plugin_t *old_plugin_p
)
This macro should be used as a statement. It declares a private variable (whose name begins with an underscore) that is needed by the other macros in this section. Failing to include this correctly should lead to a syntax error. For compatibility with C89 C compilers it should be placed in a block before any executable statements.
void DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION
This is an (almost) drop-in replacement for the system nl_langinfo(3)
, taking the same item
parameter values, and returning the same information. But it is more thread-safe than regular nl_langinfo()
, and hides the quirks of Perl's locale handling from your code, and can be used on systems that lack a native nl_langinfo
.
Expanding on these:
The reason it isn't quite a drop-in replacement is actually an advantage. The only difference is that it returns const char *
, whereas plain nl_langinfo()
returns char *
, but you are (only by documentation) forbidden to write into the buffer. By declaring this const
, the compiler enforces this restriction, so if it is violated, you know at compilation time, rather than getting segfaults at runtime.
It delivers the correct results for the RADIXCHAR
and THOUSEP
items, without you having to write extra code. The reason for the extra code would be because these are from the LC_NUMERIC
locale category, which is normally kept set by Perl so that the radix is a dot, and the separator is the empty string, no matter what the underlying locale is supposed to be, and so to get the expected results, you have to temporarily toggle into the underlying locale, and later toggle back. (You could use plain nl_langinfo
and "STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING"
for this but then you wouldn't get the other advantages of Perl_langinfo()
; not keeping LC_NUMERIC
in the C (or equivalent) locale would break a lot of CPAN, which is expecting the radix (decimal point) character to be a dot.)
The system function it replaces can have its static return buffer trashed, not only by a subesequent call to that function, but by a freelocale
, setlocale
, or other locale change. The returned buffer of this function is not changed until the next call to it, so the buffer is never in a trashed state.
Its return buffer is per-thread, so it also is never overwritten by a call to this function from another thread; unlike the function it replaces.
But most importantly, it works on systems that don't have nl_langinfo
, such as Windows, hence makes your code more portable. Of the fifty-some possible items specified by the POSIX 2008 standard, http://pubs.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/basedefs/langinfo.h.html, only one is completely unimplemented, though on non-Windows platforms, another significant one is also not implemented). It uses various techniques to recover the other items, including calling localeconv(3)
, and strftime(3)
, both of which are specified in C89, so should be always be available. Later strftime()
versions have additional capabilities; ""
is returned for those not available on your system.
It is important to note that when called with an item that is recovered by using localeconv
, the buffer from any previous explicit call to localeconv
will be overwritten. This means you must save that buffer's contents if you need to access them after a call to this function. (But note that you might not want to be using localeconv()
directly anyway, because of issues like the ones listed in the second item of this list (above) for RADIXCHAR
and THOUSEP
. You can use the methods given in perlcall to call "localeconv" in POSIX and avoid all the issues, but then you have a hash to unpack).
The details for those items which may deviate from what this emulation returns and what a native nl_langinfo()
would return are specified in I18N::Langinfo.
When using Perl_langinfo
on systems that don't have a native nl_langinfo()
, you must
#include "perl_langinfo.h"
before the perl.h
#include
. You can replace your langinfo.h
#include
with this one. (Doing it this way keeps out the symbols that plain langinfo.h
would try to import into the namespace for code that doesn't need it.)
The original impetus for Perl_langinfo()
was so that code that needs to find out the current currency symbol, floating point radix character, or digit grouping separator can use, on all systems, the simpler and more thread-friendly nl_langinfo
API instead of localeconv(3)
which is a pain to make thread-friendly. For other fields returned by localeconv
, it is better to use the methods given in perlcall to call POSIX::localeconv()
, which is thread-friendly.
const char* Perl_langinfo(const nl_item item)
This is an (almost) drop-in replacement for the system setlocale(3)
, taking the same parameters, and returning the same information, except that it returns the correct underlying LC_NUMERIC
locale. Regular setlocale
will instead return C
if the underlying locale has a non-dot decimal point character, or a non-empty thousands separator for displaying floating point numbers. This is because perl keeps that locale category such that it has a dot and empty separator, changing the locale briefly during the operations where the underlying one is required. Perl_setlocale
knows about this, and compensates; regular setlocale
doesn't.
Another reason it isn't completely a drop-in replacement is that it is declared to return const char *
, whereas the system setlocale omits the const
(presumably because its API was specified long ago, and can't be updated; it is illegal to change the information setlocale
returns; doing so leads to segfaults.)
Finally, Perl_setlocale
works under all circumstances, whereas plain setlocale
can be completely ineffective on some platforms under some configurations.
Perl_setlocale
should not be used to change the locale except on systems where the predefined variable ${^SAFE_LOCALES}
is 1. On some such systems, the system setlocale()
is ineffective, returning the wrong information, and failing to actually change the locale. Perl_setlocale
, however works properly in all circumstances.
The return points to a per-thread static buffer, which is overwritten the next time Perl_setlocale
is called from the same thread.
const char* Perl_setlocale(const int category,
const char* locale)
This is used in conjunction with one of the macros "STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED" and "STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING" to properly restore the LC_NUMERIC
state.
A call to "DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION" must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro and the two STORE
ones. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{
DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION;
...
RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC();
...
}
void RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC()
This is used by XS code that that is LC_NUMERIC
locale-aware to force the locale for category LC_NUMERIC
to be what perl thinks is the current underlying locale. (The perl interpreter could be wrong about what the underlying locale actually is if some C or XS code has called the C library function setlocale(3) behind its back; calling "sync_locale" before calling this macro will update perl's records.)
A call to "DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION" must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{
DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION;
...
STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING();
...
RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC();
...
}
The private variable is used to save the current locale state, so that the requisite matching call to "RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC" can restore it.
On threaded perls not operating with thread-safe functionality, this macro uses a mutex to force a critical section. Therefore the matching RESTORE should be close by, and guaranteed to be called.
void STORE_LC_NUMERIC_FORCE_TO_UNDERLYING()
This is used to help wrap XS or C code that is LC_NUMERIC
locale-aware. This locale category is generally kept set to a locale where the decimal radix character is a dot, and the separator between groups of digits is empty. This is because most XS code that reads floating point numbers is expecting them to have this syntax.
This macro makes sure the current LC_NUMERIC
state is set properly, to be aware of locale if the call to the XS or C code from the Perl program is from within the scope of a use locale
; or to ignore locale if the call is instead from outside such scope.
This macro is the start of wrapping the C or XS code; the wrap ending is done by calling the "RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC" macro after the operation. Otherwise the state can be changed that will adversely affect other XS code.
A call to "DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION" must have been made to declare at compile time a private variable used by this macro. This macro should be called as a single statement, not an expression, but with an empty argument list, like this:
{
DECLARATION_FOR_LC_NUMERIC_MANIPULATION;
...
STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED();
...
RESTORE_LC_NUMERIC();
...
}
On threaded perls not operating with thread-safe functionality, this macro uses a mutex to force a critical section. Therefore the matching RESTORE should be close by, and guaranteed to be called.
void STORE_LC_NUMERIC_SET_TO_NEEDED()
On systems without locale support, or on typical single-threaded builds, or on platforms that do not support per-thread locale operations, this function does nothing. On such systems that do have locale support, only a locale global to the whole program is available.
On multi-threaded builds on systems that do have per-thread locale operations, this function converts the thread it is running in to use the global locale. This is for code that has not yet or cannot be updated to handle multi-threaded locale operation. As long as only a single thread is so-converted, everything works fine, as all the other threads continue to ignore the global one, so only this thread looks at it.
However, on Windows systems this isn't quite true prior to Visual Studio 15, at which point Microsoft fixed a bug. A race can occur if you use the following operations on earlier Windows platforms:
CRNCYSTR
and THOUSEP
CRNCYSTR
and THOUSEP
The first item is not fixable (except by upgrading to a later Visual Studio release), but it would be possible to work around the latter two items by using the Windows API functions GetNumberFormat
and GetCurrencyFormat
; patches welcome.
Without this function call, threads that use the setlocale(3)
system function will not work properly, as all the locale-sensitive functions will look at the per-thread locale, and setlocale
will have no effect on this thread.
Perl code should convert to either call Perl_setlocale
(which is a drop-in for the system setlocale
) or use the methods given in perlcall to call POSIX::setlocale
. Either one will transparently properly handle all cases of single- vs multi-thread, POSIX 2008-supported or not.
Non-Perl libraries, such as gtk
, that call the system setlocale
can continue to work if this function is called before transferring control to the library.
Upon return from the code that needs to use the global locale, sync_locale()
should be called to restore the safe multi-thread operation.
void switch_to_global_locale()
Perl_setlocale
can be used at any time to query or change the locale (though changing the locale is antisocial and dangerous on multi-threaded systems that don't have multi-thread safe locale operations. (See "Multi-threaded operation" in perllocale). Using the system setlocale(3)
should be avoided. Nevertheless, certain non-Perl libraries called from XS, such as Gtk
do so, and this can't be changed. When the locale is changed by XS code that didn't use Perl_setlocale
, Perl needs to be told that the locale has changed. Use this function to do so, before returning to Perl.
The return value is a boolean: TRUE if the global locale at the time of call was in effect; and FALSE if a per-thread locale was in effect. This can be used by the caller that needs to restore things as-they-were to decide whether or not to call Perl_switch_to_global_locale
.
bool sync_locale()
Clear something magical that the SV represents. See "sv_magic"
.
int mg_clear(SV* sv)
Copies the magic from one SV to another. See "sv_magic"
.
int mg_copy(SV *sv, SV *nsv, const char *key,
I32 klen)
Finds the magic pointer for type
matching the SV. See "sv_magic"
.
MAGIC* mg_find(const SV* sv, int type)
Finds the magic pointer of type
with the given vtbl
for the SV
. See "sv_magicext"
.
MAGIC* mg_findext(const SV* sv, int type,
const MGVTBL *vtbl)
Free any magic storage used by the SV. See "sv_magic"
.
int mg_free(SV* sv)
Remove any magic of type how
using virtual table vtbl
from the SV sv
. See "sv_magic".
mg_freeext(sv, how, NULL)
is equivalent to mg_free_type(sv, how)
.
void mg_freeext(SV* sv, int how, const MGVTBL *vtbl)
Remove any magic of type how
from the SV sv
. See "sv_magic".
void mg_free_type(SV *sv, int how)
Do magic before a value is retrieved from the SV. The type of SV must be >= SVt_PVMG
. See "sv_magic"
.
int mg_get(SV* sv)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Reports on the SV's length in bytes, calling length magic if available, but does not set the UTF8 flag on sv
. It will fall back to 'get' magic if there is no 'length' magic, but with no indication as to whether it called 'get' magic. It assumes sv
is a PVMG
or higher. Use "sv_len" instead.
U32 mg_length(SV* sv)
Turns on the magical status of an SV. See "sv_magic"
.
void mg_magical(SV* sv)
Do magic after a value is assigned to the SV. See "sv_magic"
.
int mg_set(SV* sv)
Invokes mg_get
on an SV if it has 'get' magic. For example, this will call FETCH
on a tied variable. This macro evaluates its argument more than once.
void SvGETMAGIC(SV* sv)
Arranges for a mutual exclusion lock to be obtained on sv
if a suitable module has been loaded.
void SvLOCK(SV* sv)
Invokes mg_set
on an SV if it has 'set' magic. This is necessary after modifying a scalar, in case it is a magical variable like $|
or a tied variable (it calls STORE
). This macro evaluates its argument more than once.
void SvSETMAGIC(SV* sv)
Like SvSetSV
, but does any set magic required afterwards.
void SvSetMagicSV(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Like SvSetSV_nosteal
, but does any set magic required afterwards.
void SvSetMagicSV_nosteal(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Calls sv_setsv
if dsv
is not the same as ssv
. May evaluate arguments more than once. Does not handle 'set' magic on the destination SV.
void SvSetSV(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Calls a non-destructive version of sv_setsv
if dsv
is not the same as ssv
. May evaluate arguments more than once.
void SvSetSV_nosteal(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Arranges for sv
to be shared between threads if a suitable module has been loaded.
void SvSHARE(SV* sv)
Generates the message string describing an OS error and returns it as an SV. errnum
must be a value that errno
could take, identifying the type of error.
If tgtsv
is non-null then the string will be written into that SV (overwriting existing content) and it will be returned. If tgtsv
is a null pointer then the string will be written into a new mortal SV which will be returned.
The message will be taken from whatever locale would be used by $!
, and will be encoded in the SV in whatever manner would be used by $!
. The details of this process are subject to future change. Currently, the message is taken from the C locale by default (usually producing an English message), and from the currently selected locale when in the scope of the use locale
pragma. A heuristic attempt is made to decode the message from the locale's character encoding, but it will only be decoded as either UTF-8 or ISO-8859-1. It is always correctly decoded in a UTF-8 locale, usually in an ISO-8859-1 locale, and never in any other locale.
The SV is always returned containing an actual string, and with no other OK bits set. Unlike $!
, a message is even yielded for errnum
zero (meaning success), and if no useful message is available then a useless string (currently empty) is returned.
SV * sv_string_from_errnum(int errnum, SV *tgtsv)
Releases a mutual exclusion lock on sv
if a suitable module has been loaded.
void SvUNLOCK(SV* sv)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C memcpy
function. The src
is the source, dest
is the destination, nitems
is the number of items, and type
is the type. May fail on overlapping copies. See also "Move"
.
void Copy(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
Like Copy
but returns dest
. Useful for encouraging compilers to tail-call optimise.
void * CopyD(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C memmove
function. The src
is the source, dest
is the destination, nitems
is the number of items, and type
is the type. Can do overlapping moves. See also "Copy"
.
void Move(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
Like Move
but returns dest
. Useful for encouraging compilers to tail-call optimise.
void * MoveD(void* src, void* dest, int nitems, type)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C malloc
function.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with "Safefree".
In 5.9.3, Newx() and friends replace the older New() API, and drops the first parameter, x, a debug aid which allowed callers to identify themselves. This aid has been superseded by a new build option, PERL_MEM_LOG (see "PERL_MEM_LOG" in perlhacktips). The older API is still there for use in XS modules supporting older perls.
void Newx(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C malloc
function, with cast. See also "Newx"
.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with "Safefree".
void Newxc(void* ptr, int nitems, type, cast)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C malloc
function. The allocated memory is zeroed with memzero
. See also "Newx"
.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with "Safefree".
void Newxz(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
PoisonWith(0xEF) for catching access to freed memory.
void Poison(void* dest, int nitems, type)
PoisonWith(0xEF) for catching access to freed memory.
void PoisonFree(void* dest, int nitems, type)
PoisonWith(0xAB) for catching access to allocated but uninitialized memory.
void PoisonNew(void* dest, int nitems, type)
Fill up memory with a byte pattern (a byte repeated over and over again) that hopefully catches attempts to access uninitialized memory.
void PoisonWith(void* dest, int nitems, type,
U8 byte)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C realloc
function.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with "Safefree".
void Renew(void* ptr, int nitems, type)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C realloc
function, with cast.
Memory obtained by this should ONLY be freed with "Safefree".
void Renewc(void* ptr, int nitems, type, cast)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C free
function.
This should ONLY be used on memory obtained using "Newx" and friends.
void Safefree(void* ptr)
Perl's version of strdup()
. Returns a pointer to a newly allocated string which is a duplicate of pv
. The size of the string is determined by strlen()
, which means it may not contain embedded NUL
characters and must have a trailing NUL
. The memory allocated for the new string can be freed with the Safefree()
function.
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedpv"
.
char* savepv(const char* pv)
Perl's version of what strndup()
would be if it existed. Returns a pointer to a newly allocated string which is a duplicate of the first len
bytes from pv
, plus a trailing NUL
byte. The memory allocated for the new string can be freed with the "Safefree" function.
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedpvn".
char* savepvn(const char* pv, I32 len)
Like savepvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
char* savepvs("literal string" s)
A version of "savepv" which allocates the duplicate string in memory which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedpv(const char* pv)
A version of "savepvn" which allocates the duplicate string in memory which is shared between threads. (With the specific difference that a NULL
pointer is not acceptable)
char* savesharedpvn(const char *const pv,
const STRLEN len)
A version of savepvs()
which allocates the duplicate string in memory which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedpvs("literal string" s)
A version of "savesharedpv" which allocates the duplicate string in memory which is shared between threads.
char* savesharedsvpv(SV *sv)
A version of "savepv"/"savepvn" which gets the string to duplicate from the passed in SV using "SvPV"
On some platforms, Windows for example, all allocated memory owned by a thread is deallocated when that thread ends. So if you need that not to happen, you need to use the shared memory functions, such as "savesharedsvpv".
char* savesvpv(SV* sv)
This is an architecture-independent macro to copy one structure to another.
void StructCopy(type *src, type *dest, type)
The XSUB-writer's interface to the C memzero
function. The dest
is the destination, nitems
is the number of items, and type
is the type.
void Zero(void* dest, int nitems, type)
Like Zero
but returns dest. Useful for encouraging compilers to tail-call optimise.
void * ZeroD(void* dest, int nitems, type)
Dumps the C backtrace to the given fp
.
Returns true if a backtrace could be retrieved, false if not.
bool dump_c_backtrace(PerlIO* fp, int max_depth,
int skip)
Fill sv
with the current working directory, supporting long pathnames. Implements the potentially insecure fastcwd API, without resolving symlinks. This is the more dangerous variant because you might chdir out of a directory that you can't chdir back into. For the safe variant prepend it with abs_path or use getcwd_sv.
int fastcwd_sv(SV* sv)
Analyzes the string in order to make fast searches on it using fbm_instr()
-- the Boyer-Moore algorithm.
void fbm_compile(SV* sv, U32 flags)
Returns the location of the SV in the string delimited by big
and bigend
. It returns NULL
if the string can't be found. The sv
does not have to be fbm_compiled
, but the search will not be as fast then.
char* fbm_instr(unsigned char* big,
unsigned char* bigend, SV* littlestr,
U32 flags)
Returns true if the leading len
bytes of the strings s1
and s2
are the same case-insensitively; false otherwise. Uppercase and lowercase ASCII range bytes match themselves and their opposite case counterparts. Non-cased and non-ASCII range bytes match only themselves.
I32 foldEQ(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
Returns true if the leading len
bytes of the strings s1
and s2
are the same case-insensitively in the current locale; false otherwise.
I32 foldEQ_locale(const char* a, const char* b,
I32 len)
Takes a sprintf-style format pattern and conventional (non-SV) arguments and returns the formatted string.
(char *) Perl_form(pTHX_ const char* pat, ...)
can be used any place a string (char *) is required:
char * s = Perl_form("%d.%d",major,minor);
Uses a single private buffer so if you want to format several strings you must explicitly copy the earlier strings away (and free the copies when you are done).
char* form(const char* pat, ...)
Fill sv
with current working directory, supporting long pathnames. Implements the secure getcwd API, with resolving symlinks.
int getcwd_sv(SV* sv)
Returns a SV containing a dump of depth
frames of the call stack, skipping the skip
innermost ones. depth
of 20 is usually enough.
The appended output looks like:
... 1 10e004812:0082 Perl_croak util.c:1716 /usr/bin/perl 2 10df8d6d2:1d72 perl_parse perl.c:3975 /usr/bin/perl ...
The fields are tab-separated. The first column is the depth (zero being the innermost non-skipped frame). In the hex:offset, the hex is where the program counter was in S_parse_body
, and the :offset (might be missing) tells how much inside the S_parse_body
the program counter was.
The util.c:1716
is the source code file and line number.
The /usr/bin/perl is obvious (hopefully).
Unknowns are "-"
. Unknowns can happen unfortunately quite easily: if the platform doesn't support retrieving the information; if the binary is missing the debug information; if the optimizer has transformed the code by for example inlining.
SV* get_c_backtrace_dump(int max_depth, int skip)
This is a synonym for (! foldEQ())
I32 ibcmp(const char* a, const char* b, I32 len)
This is a synonym for (! foldEQ_locale())
I32 ibcmp_locale(const char* a, const char* b,
I32 len)
Test that the given pv
doesn't contain any internal NUL
characters. If it does, set errno
to ENOENT
, optionally warn with the 'syscalls' category, and return FALSE. If warnings 'security' is in effect it overrides the 'syscalls' warnings category. I.e. to turn it off you have turn off both: no warnings ('syscalls', 'io');
Note: With cperl 'syscalls' and 'security' are both default ON.
Return TRUE if the name is safe.
Used by the IS_SAFE_SYSCALL()
macro.
bool is_safe_syscall(const char *pv, STRLEN len,
const char *what,
const char *op_name)
Test two buffers (which may contain embedded NUL
characters, to see if they are equal. The len
parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare. Returns zero if equal, or non-zero if non-equal.
bool memEQ(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
Test two buffers (which may contain embedded NUL
characters, to see if they are not equal. The len
parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare. Returns zero if non-equal, or non-zero if equal.
bool memNE(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* mess(const char* pat, ...)
Expands a message, intended for the user, to include an indication of the current location in the code, if the message does not already appear to be complete.
basemsg
is the initial message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is and will be the result of this function. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it already ends with a newline, it is taken to be complete, and the result of this function will be the same string. If the message does not end with a newline, then a segment such as at foo.pl line 37
will be appended, and possibly other clauses indicating the current state of execution. The resulting message will end with a dot and a newline.
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function. If consume
is true, then the function is permitted (but not required) to modify and return basemsg
instead of allocating a new SV.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* mess_sv(SV* basemsg, bool consume)
The C library snprintf
functionality, if available and standards-compliant (uses vsnprintf
, actually). However, if the vsnprintf
is not available, will unfortunately use the unsafe vsprintf
which can overrun the buffer (there is an overrun check, but that may be too late). Consider using sv_vcatpvf
instead, or getting vsnprintf
.
int my_snprintf(char *buffer, const Size_t len,
const char *format, ...)
The C library strlcat
if available, or a Perl implementation of it. This operates on C NUL
-terminated strings.
my_strlcat()
appends string src
to the end of dst
. It will append at most size - strlen(dst) - 1
characters. It will then NUL
-terminate, unless size
is 0 or the original dst
string was longer than size
(in practice this should not happen as it means that either size
is incorrect or that dst
is not a proper NUL
-terminated string).
Note that size
is the full size of the destination buffer and the result is guaranteed to be NUL
-terminated if there is room. Note that room for the NUL
should be included in size
.
The return value is the total length that dst
would have if size
is sufficiently large. Thus it is the initial length of dst
plus the length of src
. If size
is smaller than the return, the excess was not appended.
Size_t my_strlcat(char *dst, const char *src,
Size_t size)
The C library strlcpy
if available, or a Perl implementation of it. This operates on C NUL
-terminated strings.
my_strlcpy()
copies up to size - 1
characters from the string src
to dst
, NUL
-terminating the result if size
is not 0.
The return value is the total length src
would be if the copy completely succeeded. If it is larger than size
, the excess was not copied.
Size_t my_strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src,
Size_t size)
The C library strnlen
if available, or a Perl implementation of it.
my_strnlen()
computes the length of the string, up to maxlen
characters. It will will never attempt to address more than maxlen
characters, making it suitable for use with strings that are not guaranteed to be NUL-terminated.
Size_t my_strnlen(const char *str, Size_t maxlen)
The C library vsnprintf
if available and standards-compliant. However, if if the vsnprintf
is not available, will unfortunately use the unsafe vsprintf
which can overrun the buffer (there is an overrun check, but that may be too late). Consider using sv_vcatpvf
instead, or getting vsnprintf
.
int my_vsnprintf(char *buffer, const Size_t len,
const char *format, va_list ap)
Find the first (leftmost) occurrence of a sequence of bytes within another sequence. This is the Perl version of strstr()
, extended to handle arbitrary sequences, potentially containing embedded NUL
characters (NUL
is what the initial n
in the function name stands for; some systems have an equivalent, memmem()
, but with a somewhat different API).
Another way of thinking about this function is finding a needle in a haystack. big
points to the first byte in the haystack. big_end
points to one byte beyond the final byte in the haystack. little
points to the first byte in the needle. little_end
points to one byte beyond the final byte in the needle. All the parameters must be non-NULL
.
The function returns NULL
if there is no occurrence of little
within big
. If little
is the empty string, big
is returned.
Because this function operates at the byte level, and because of the inherent characteristics of UTF-8 (or UTF-EBCDIC), it will work properly if both the needle and the haystack are strings with the same UTF-8ness, but not if the UTF-8ness differs.
char * ninstr(char * big, char * bigend, char * little,
char * little_end)
Provides system-specific tune up of the C runtime environment necessary to run Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, before creating any Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_INIT(int *argc, char*** argv)
Provides system-specific tune up of the C runtime environment necessary to run Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, before creating any Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_INIT3(int *argc, char*** argv,
char*** env)
Provides system-specific clean up of the C runtime environment after running Perl interpreters. This should be called only once, after freeing any remaining Perl interpreters.
void PERL_SYS_TERM()
Translate the ffi_call return value back to the perl type. The types were declared as sub attribute, defaulting to :void, same as perl6.
Via use ffi there are more types than coretypes supported: void, ptr, float, double, long, ulong, char, byte (U8), int8, int16, int64, uint8, uint16, uint32, uint64, longlong, num32, num64, longdouble, bool, size_t, Pointer, OpaquePointer (deprecated), but they need a declaration via use ffi
.
void prep_ffi_ret(CV* cv, SV** sp, char *rvalue)
Check the given arguments for type and arity, and fill the void* argvalue[] array with it. Similar to pp_signature
, just matching ffi types to libffi, not coretypes to perl types.
The ffi_cif at CvFFLIB(cv) contains information describing the data types, sizes and alignments of the arguments to and return value from fn. See man ffi_call
.
void prep_ffi_sig(CV* cv,
const unsigned int num_args,
SV** argp, void **argvalues)
quadmath_format_needed()
returns true if the format
string seems to contain at least one non-Q-prefixed %[efgaEFGA]
format specifier, or returns false otherwise.
The format specifier detection is not complete printf-syntax detection, but it should catch most common cases.
If true is returned, those arguments should in theory be processed with quadmath_snprintf()
, but in case there is more than one such format specifier (see "quadmath_format_single"), and if there is anything else beyond that one (even just a single byte), they cannot be processed because quadmath_snprintf()
is very strict, accepting only one format spec, and nothing else. In this case, the code should probably fail.
bool quadmath_format_needed(const char* format)
quadmath_snprintf()
is very strict about its format
string and will fail, returning -1, if the format is invalid. It accepts exactly one format spec.
quadmath_format_single()
checks that the intended single spec looks sane: begins with %
, has only one %
, ends with [efgaEFGA]
, and has Q
before it. This is not a full "printf syntax check", just the basics.
Returns the format if it is valid, NULL if not.
quadmath_format_single()
can and will actually patch in the missing Q
, if necessary. In this case it will return the modified copy of the format, which the caller will need to free.
See also "quadmath_format_needed".
const char* quadmath_format_single(const char* format)
Returns the value of an ASCII-range hex digit and advances the string pointer. Behaviour is only well defined when isXDIGIT(*str) is true.
U8 READ_XDIGIT(char str*)
Like "ninstr"
, but instead finds the final (rightmost) occurrence of a sequence of bytes within another sequence, returning NULL
if there is no such occurrence.
char * rninstr(char * big, char * bigend,
char * little, char * little_end)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Sets a VERSION dualvar to its string and NV parts.
Synopsis:
set_version(SvPV(version), SvCUR(version), "0.01_01", sizeof("0.01_01")-1, 0.0101);
Perl_set_version(aTHX_ STR_WITH_LEN("Module::VERSION"), STR_WITH_LEN("0.01_01"), 0.0101);
void set_version(const char *name, STRLEN nlen,
const char *strval, STRLEN plen,
NV nvval)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if they are equal. Returns true or false.
bool strEQ(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if the first, s1
, is greater than or equal to the second, s2
. Returns true or false.
bool strGE(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if the first, s1
, is greater than the second, s2
. Returns true or false.
bool strGT(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if the first, s1
, is less than or equal to the second, s2
. Returns true or false.
bool strLE(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if the first, s1
, is less than the second, s2
. Returns true or false.
bool strLT(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if they are different. Returns true or false.
bool strNE(char* s1, char* s2)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if they are equal. The len
parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare. Returns true or false. (A wrapper for strncmp
).
bool strnEQ(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
Test two NUL
-terminated strings to see if they are different. The len
parameter indicates the number of bytes to compare. Returns true or false. (A wrapper for strncmp
).
bool strnNE(char* s1, char* s2, STRLEN len)
Dummy routine which reports that object can be destroyed when there is no sharing module present. It ignores its single SV argument, and returns 'true'. Exists to avoid test for a NULL
function pointer and because it could potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
bool sv_destroyable(SV *sv)
Dummy routine which "shares" an SV when there is no sharing module present. Or "locks" it. Or "unlocks" it. In other words, ignores its single SV argument. Exists to avoid test for a NULL
function pointer and because it could potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
void sv_nosharing(SV *sv)
pat
and args
are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated argument list, respectively. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
Normally, the resulting message is returned in a new mortal SV. During global destruction a single SV may be shared between uses of this function.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* vmess(const char* pat, va_list* args)
These functions are related to the method resolution order of perl classes
Returns the mro linearisation for the given stash. By default, this will be whatever mro_get_linear_isa_dfs
returns unless some other MRO is in effect for the stash. The return value is a read-only AV*.
You are responsible for SvREFCNT_inc()
on the return value if you plan to store it anywhere semi-permanently (otherwise it might be deleted out from under you the next time the cache is invalidated).
AV* mro_get_linear_isa(HV* stash)
Takes the necessary steps (cache invalidations, mostly) when the @ISA
of the given package has changed. Invoked by the setisa
magic, should not need to invoke directly.
void mro_isa_changed_in(HV* stash)
Invalidates method caching on any child classes of the given stash, so that they might notice the changes in this one.
Ideally, all instances of PL_sub_generation++
in perl source outside of mro.c should be replaced by calls to this.
Perl automatically handles most of the common ways a method might be redefined. However, there are a few ways you could change a method in a stash without the cache code noticing, in which case you need to call this method afterwards:
1) Directly manipulating the stash HV entries from XS code.
2) Assigning a reference to a readonly scalar constant into a stash entry in order to create a constant subroutine (like constant.pm does).
This same method is available from pure perl via, mro::method_changed_in(classname)
.
void mro_method_changed_in(HV* stash)
Registers a custom mro plugin. See perlmroapi for details.
void mro_register(const struct mro_alg *mro)
Declare local variables for a multicall. See "LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS" in perlcall.
dMULTICALL;
Make a lightweight callback. See "LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS" in perlcall.
MULTICALL;
Closing bracket for a lightweight callback. See "LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS" in perlcall.
POP_MULTICALL;
Opening bracket for a lightweight callback. See "LIGHTWEIGHT CALLBACKS" in perlcall.
PUSH_MULTICALL;
converts a string representing a binary number to numeric form.
On entry start
and *len
give the string to scan, *flags
gives conversion flags, and result
should be NULL
or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT
is set in *flags
, encountering an invalid character will also trigger a warning. On return *len
is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags
gives output flags.
If the value is <= UV_MAX
it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result
. If the value is > UV_MAX
, grok_bin
returns UV_MAX
, sets PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX
in the output flags, and writes the value to *result
(or the value is discarded if result
is NULL).
The binary number may optionally be prefixed with "0b"
or "b"
unless PERL_SCAN_DISALLOW_PREFIX
is set in *flags
on entry. If PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES
is set in *flags
then the binary number may use "_"
characters to separate digits.
UV grok_bin(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p,
I32* flags, NV *result)
converts a string representing a hex number to numeric form.
On entry start
and *len_p
give the string to scan, *flags
gives conversion flags, and result
should be NULL
or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT
is set in *flags
, encountering an invalid character will also trigger a warning. On return *len
is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags
gives output flags.
If the value is <= UV_MAX
it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result
. If the value is > UV_MAX
, grok_hex
returns UV_MAX
, sets PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX
in the output flags, and writes the value to *result
(or the value is discarded if result
is NULL
).
The hex number may optionally be prefixed with "0x"
or "x"
unless PERL_SCAN_DISALLOW_PREFIX
is set in *flags
on entry. If PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES
is set in *flags
then the hex number may use "_"
characters to separate digits.
UV grok_hex(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p,
I32* flags, NV *result)
Helper for grok_number()
, accepts various ways of spelling "infinity" or "not a number", and returns one of the following flag combinations:
IS_NUMBER_INFINITY
IS_NUMBER_NAN
IS_NUMBER_INFINITY | IS_NUMBER_NEG
IS_NUMBER_NAN | IS_NUMBER_NEG
0
possibly |-ed with IS_NUMBER_TRAILING
.
If an infinity or a not-a-number is recognized, *sp
will point to one byte past the end of the recognized string. If the recognition fails, zero is returned, and *sp
will not move.
int grok_infnan(const char** sp, const char *send)
Identical to grok_number_flags()
with flags
set to zero.
int grok_number(const char *pv, STRLEN len,
UV *valuep)
Recognise (or not) a number. The type of the number is returned (0 if unrecognised), otherwise it is a bit-ORed combination of IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
, IS_NUMBER_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX
, IS_NUMBER_NOT_INT
, IS_NUMBER_NEG
, IS_NUMBER_INFINITY
, IS_NUMBER_NAN
(defined in perl.h).
If the value of the number can fit in a UV, it is returned in *valuep
. IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
will be set to indicate that *valuep
is valid, IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
will never be set unless *valuep
is valid, but *valuep
may have been assigned to during processing even though IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
is not set on return. If valuep
is NULL
, IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
will be set for the same cases as when valuep
is non-NULL
, but no actual assignment (or SEGV) will occur.
IS_NUMBER_NOT_INT
will be set with IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
if trailing decimals were seen (in which case *valuep
gives the true value truncated to an integer), and IS_NUMBER_NEG
if the number is negative (in which case *valuep
holds the absolute value). IS_NUMBER_IN_UV
is not set if e notation was used or the number is larger than a UV.
flags
allows only PERL_SCAN_TRAILING
, which allows for trailing non-numeric text on an otherwise successful grok, setting IS_NUMBER_TRAILING
on the result.
int grok_number_flags(const char *pv, STRLEN len,
UV *valuep, U32 flags)
Scan and skip for a numeric decimal separator (radix).
bool grok_numeric_radix(const char **sp,
const char *send)
converts a string representing an octal number to numeric form.
On entry start
and *len
give the string to scan, *flags
gives conversion flags, and result
should be NULL
or a pointer to an NV. The scan stops at the end of the string, or the first invalid character. Unless PERL_SCAN_SILENT_ILLDIGIT
is set in *flags
, encountering an 8 or 9 will also trigger a warning. On return *len
is set to the length of the scanned string, and *flags
gives output flags.
If the value is <= UV_MAX
it is returned as a UV, the output flags are clear, and nothing is written to *result
. If the value is > UV_MAX
, grok_oct
returns UV_MAX
, sets PERL_SCAN_GREATER_THAN_UV_MAX
in the output flags, and writes the value to *result
(or the value is discarded if result
is NULL
).
If PERL_SCAN_ALLOW_UNDERSCORES
is set in *flags
then the octal number may use "_"
characters to separate digits.
UV grok_oct(const char* start, STRLEN* len_p,
I32* flags, NV *result)
Perl_isinfnan()
is utility function that returns true if the NV argument is either an infinity or a NaN
, false otherwise. To test in more detail, use Perl_isinf()
and Perl_isnan()
.
This is also the logical inverse of Perl_isfinite().
bool isinfnan(NV nv)
This function is equivalent to the libc strtod() function, and is available even on platforms that lack plain strtod(). Its return value is the best available precision depending on platform capabilities and Configure options.
It properly handles the locale radix character, meaning it expects a dot except when called from within the scope of use locale
, in which case the radix character should be that specified by the current locale.
The synonym Strod() may be used instead.
NV my_strtod(const char * const s, char ** e)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Return a non-zero integer if the sign bit on an NV is set, and 0 if it is not.
If Configure detects this system has a signbit()
that will work with our NVs, then we just use it via the #define
in perl.h. Otherwise, fall back on this implementation. The main use of this function is catching -0.0
.
Configure
notes: This function is called 'Perl_signbit'
instead of a plain 'signbit'
because it is easy to imagine a system having a signbit()
function or macro that doesn't happen to work with our particular choice of NVs. We shouldn't just re-#define
signbit
as Perl_signbit
and expect the standard system headers to be happy. Also, this is a no-context function (no pTHX_
) because Perl_signbit()
is usually re-#defined
in perl.h as a simple macro call to the system's signbit()
. Users should just always call Perl_signbit()
.
int Perl_signbit(NV f)
For backwards compatibility. Use grok_bin
instead.
NV scan_bin(const char* start, STRLEN len,
STRLEN* retlen)
For backwards compatibility. Use grok_hex
instead.
NV scan_hex(const char* start, STRLEN len,
STRLEN* retlen)
For backwards compatibility. Use grok_oct
instead.
NV scan_oct(const char* start, STRLEN len,
STRLEN* retlen)
Some of these are also deprecated. You can exclude these from your compiled Perl by adding this option to Configure: -Accflags='-DNO_MATHOMS'
Return the description of a given custom op. This was once used by the OP_DESC
macro, but is no longer: it has only been kept for compatibility, and should not be used.
const char * custom_op_desc(const OP *o)
Return the name for a given custom op. This was once used by the OP_NAME
macro, but is no longer: it has only been kept for compatibility, and should not be used.
const char * custom_op_name(const OP *o)
See "gv_fetchmethod_autoload".
GV* gv_fetchmethod(HV* stash, const char* name)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Tests if some arbitrary number of bytes begins in a valid UTF-8 character. Note that an INVARIANT (i.e. ASCII on non-EBCDIC machines) character is a valid UTF-8 character. The actual number of bytes in the UTF-8 character will be returned if it is valid, otherwise 0.
This function is deprecated due to the possibility that malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer. Use "isUTF8_CHAR" instead.
STRLEN is_utf8_char(const U8 *s)
This is identical to the macro "isUTF8_CHAR".
STRLEN is_utf8_char_buf(const U8 *buf,
const U8 *buf_end)
The engine implementing pack()
Perl function. Note: parameters next_in_list
and flags
are not used. This call should not be used; use packlist
instead.
void pack_cat(SV *cat, const char *pat,
const char *patend, SV **beglist,
SV **endlist, SV ***next_in_list,
U32 flags)
Looks up the type of the lexical variable at position po
in the currently-compiling pad. If the variable is typed, the stash of the class to which it is typed is returned. If not, NULL
is returned.
HV * pad_compname_type(PADOFFSET po)
Return a pointer to the byte-encoded representation of the SV. May cause the SV to be downgraded from UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the SvPVbyte_nolen
macro.
char* sv_2pvbyte_nolen(SV* sv)
Return a pointer to the UTF-8-encoded representation of the SV. May cause the SV to be upgraded to UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the SvPVutf8_nolen
macro.
char* sv_2pvutf8_nolen(SV* sv)
Like sv_2pv()
, but doesn't return the length too. You should usually use the macro wrapper SvPV_nolen(sv)
instead.
char* sv_2pv_nolen(SV* sv)
Like sv_catpvn
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpvn_mg(SV *sv, const char *ptr,
STRLEN len)
Like sv_catsv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catsv_mg(SV *dsv, SV *ssv)
Undo various types of fakery on an SV: if the PV is a shared string, make a private copy; if we're a ref, stop refing; if we're a glob, downgrade to an xpvmg
. See also "sv_force_normal_flags"
.
void sv_force_normal(SV *sv)
A private implementation of the SvIVx
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
IV sv_iv(SV* sv)
Dummy routine which "locks" an SV when there is no locking module present. Exists to avoid test for a NULL
function pointer and because it could potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
"Superseded" by sv_nosharing()
.
void sv_nolocking(SV *sv)
Dummy routine which "unlocks" an SV when there is no locking module present. Exists to avoid test for a NULL
function pointer and because it could potentially warn under some level of strict-ness.
"Superseded" by sv_nosharing()
.
void sv_nounlocking(SV *sv)
A private implementation of the SvNVx
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
NV sv_nv(SV* sv)
Use the SvPV_nolen
macro instead
char* sv_pv(SV *sv)
Use SvPVbyte_nolen
instead.
char* sv_pvbyte(SV *sv)
A private implementation of the SvPVbyte
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvbyten(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
A private implementation of the SvPV
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvn(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
Use the SvPVutf8_nolen
macro instead
char* sv_pvutf8(SV *sv)
A private implementation of the SvPVutf8
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvutf8n(SV *sv, STRLEN *lp)
Taint an SV. Use SvTAINTED_on
instead.
void sv_taint(SV* sv)
Unsets the RV status of the SV, and decrements the reference count of whatever was being referenced by the RV. This can almost be thought of as a reversal of newSVrv
. This is sv_unref_flags
with the flag
being zero. See "SvROK_off"
.
void sv_unref(SV* sv)
Tells an SV to use ptr
to find its string value. Implemented by calling sv_usepvn_flags
with flags
of 0, hence does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_usepvn_flags"
.
void sv_usepvn(SV* sv, char* ptr, STRLEN len)
Like sv_usepvn
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_usepvn_mg(SV *sv, char *ptr, STRLEN len)
A private implementation of the SvUVx
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
UV sv_uv(SV* sv)
The engine implementing unpack()
Perl function. Note: parameters strbeg
, new_s
and ocnt
are not used. This call should not be used, use unpackstring
instead.
SSize_t unpack_str(const char *pat, const char *patend,
const char *s, const char *strbeg,
const char *strend, char **new_s,
I32 ocnt, U32 flags)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Returns the Unicode code point of the first character in the string s
which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; retlen
will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
Some, but not all, UTF-8 malformations are detected, and in fact, some malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer, which is one reason why this function is deprecated. The other is that only in extremely limited circumstances should the Unicode versus native code point be of any interest to you. See "utf8_to_uvuni_buf" for alternatives.
If s
points to one of the detected malformations, and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen
is set (if retlen
doesn't point to NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL) so that (s
+ *retlen
) is the next possible position in s
that could begin a non-malformed character. See "utf8n_to_uvchr" for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvuni(const U8 *s, STRLEN *retlen)
Constructs, checks, and returns an assignment op. left
and right
supply the parameters of the assignment; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
If optype
is OP_ANDASSIGN
, OP_ORASSIGN
, or OP_DORASSIGN
, then a suitable conditional optree is constructed. If optype
is the opcode of a binary operator, such as OP_BIT_OR
, then an op is constructed that performs the binary operation and assigns the result to the left argument. Either way, if optype
is non-zero then flags
has no effect.
If optype
is zero, then a plain scalar or list assignment is constructed. Which type of assignment it is is automatically determined. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 or 2 is automatically set as required.
OP * newASSIGNOP(I32 flags, OP *left, I32 optype,
OP *right)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any binary type. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 or 2 is automatically set as required. first
and last
supply up to two ops to be the direct children of the binary op; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newBINOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first,
OP *last)
Constructs, checks, and returns a conditional-expression (cond_expr
) op. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set. first
supplies the expression selecting between the two branches, and trueop
and falseop
supply the branches; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newCONDOP(I32 flags, OP *first, OP *trueop,
OP *falseop)
Constructs and returns an op to access $_
, either as a lexical variable (if declared as my $_
) in the current scope, or the global $_
.
OP * newDEFSVOP()
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a foreach
loop (iteration through a list of values). This is a heavyweight loop, with structure that allows exiting the loop by last
and suchlike.
sv
optionally supplies the variable that will be aliased to each item in turn; if null, it defaults to $_
(either lexical or global). expr
supplies the list of values to iterate over. block
supplies the main body of the loop, and cont
optionally supplies a continue
block that operates as a second half of the body. All of these optree inputs are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
for the leaveloop
op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
for the leaveloop
op, except that (in both cases) some bits will be set automatically.
OP * newFOROP(I32 flags, OP *sv, OP *expr, OP *block,
OP *cont)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a given
block. cond
supplies the expression that will be locally assigned to a lexical variable, and block
supplies the body of the given
construct; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree. defsv_off
is the pad offset of the scalar lexical variable that will be affected. If it is 0, the global $_
will be used.
OP * newGIVENOP(OP *cond, OP *block,
PADOFFSET defsv_off)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an embedded reference to a GV. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
. gv
identifies the GV that the op should reference; calling this function does not transfer ownership of any reference to it.
OP * newGVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, GV *gv)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any list type. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically if required. first
and last
supply up to two ops to be direct children of the list op; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
For most list operators, the check function expects all the kid ops to be present already, so calling newLISTOP(OP_JOIN, ...)
(e.g.) is not appropriate. What you want to do in that case is create an op of type OP_LIST
, append more children to it, and then call "op_convert_list". See "op_convert_list" for more information.
OP * newLISTOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first,
OP *last)
Constructs, checks, and returns a logical (flow control) op. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set. first
supplies the expression controlling the flow, and other
supplies the side (alternate) chain of ops; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newLOGOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first,
OP *other)
Constructs, checks, and returns a loop-exiting op (such as goto
or last
). type
is the opcode. label
supplies the parameter determining the target of the op; it is consumed by this function and becomes part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newLOOPEX(I32 type, OP *label)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a loop. This is only a loop in the control flow through the op tree; it does not have the heavyweight loop structure that allows exiting the loop by last
and suchlike. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
for the top-level op, except that some bits will be set automatically as required. expr
supplies the expression controlling loop iteration, and block
supplies the body of the loop; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree. debuggable
is currently unused and should always be 1.
OP * newLOOPOP(I32 flags, I32 debuggable, OP *expr,
OP *block)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of method type with a method name evaluated at runtime. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set. dynamic_meth
supplies an op which evaluates method name; it is consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
Supported optypes: METHOD, METHOD_NAMED, METHOD_SUPER, METHOD_REDIR, METHOD_REDIR_SUPER, CUSTOM.
OP * newMETHOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of method type with a constant method name. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
. const_meth
supplies a constant method name; it must be a shared COW string. Supported optypes: OP_METHOD_NAMED
.
OP * newMETHOP_named(I32 type, I32 flags,
SV *const_meth)
Constructs, checks, and returns a new stub
op, which represents an empty list expression.
OP * newNULLLIST()
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any base type (any type that has no extra fields). type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
.
OP * newOP(I32 type, I32 flags)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves a reference to a pad element. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
. A pad slot is automatically allocated, and is populated with sv
; this function takes ownership of one reference to it.
This function only exists if Perl has been compiled to use ithreads.
OP * newPADOP(I32 type, I32 flags, SV *sv)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any pattern matching type. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
.
OP * newPMOP(I32 type, I32 flags)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an embedded C-level pointer (PV). type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
. pv
supplies the C-level pointer. Depending on the op type, the memory referenced by pv
may be freed when the op is destroyed. If the op is of a freeing type, pv
must have been allocated using PerlMemShared_malloc
.
OP * newPVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, char *pv)
Constructs and returns a range
op, with subordinate flip
and flop
ops. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
for the flip
op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
for both the flip
and range
ops, except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set. left
and right
supply the expressions controlling the endpoints of the range; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newRANGE(I32 flags, OP *left, OP *right)
Constructs, checks, and returns an lslice
(list slice) op. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 or 2 is automatically set as required. listval
and subscript
supply the parameters of the slice; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newSLICEOP(I32 flags, OP *subscript,
OP *listval)
Constructs a state op (COP). The state op is normally a nextstate
op, but will be a dbstate
op if debugging is enabled for currently-compiled code. The state op is populated from PL_curcop
(or PL_compiling
). If label
is non-null, it supplies the name of a label to attach to the state op; this function takes ownership of the memory pointed at by label
, and will free it. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
for the state op.
If o
is null, the state op is returned. Otherwise the state op is combined with o
into a lineseq
list op, which is returned. o
is consumed by this function and becomes part of the returned op tree.
OP * newSTATEOP(I32 flags, char *label, OP *o)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any type that involves an embedded SV. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
. sv
gives the SV to embed in the op; this function takes ownership of one reference to it.
OP * newSVOP(I32 type, I32 flags, SV *sv)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op of any unary type. type
is the opcode. flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
, except that OPf_KIDS
will be set automatically if required, and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
, except that the bit with value 1 is automatically set. first
supplies an optional op to be the direct child of the unary op; it is consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
OP * newUNOP(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *first)
Similar to newUNOP
, but creates an UNOP_AUX
struct instead, with op_aux
initialised to aux
OP* newUNOP_AUX(I32 type, I32 flags, OP* first,
UNOP_AUX_item *aux)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a when
block. cond
supplies the test expression, and block
supplies the block that will be executed if the test evaluates to true; they are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree. cond
will be interpreted DWIMically, often as a comparison against $_
, and may be null to generate a default
block.
OP * newWHENOP(OP *cond, OP *block)
Constructs, checks, and returns an op tree expressing a while
or for
/foreach
loop or a single block
run only once. This is a heavyweight loop, with structure that allows exiting the loop by last
and suchlike.
loop
is an optional enterloop
op to use in the loop. With a foreach
loop is is an enteriter
op. This op contains the five main control paths: first, last, redoop, nextop, lastop. first
being the list iterator, last
being the iteration variable, redoop
the block
plus cont
, nextop
the cont
or an unstack
op, lastop
a leaveloop
op, which is also the false condition of the expr
(i.e. expr->op_next
).
expr
supplies the loop's controlling expression. With a foreach
loop it is the iter
op, with while
the while expression, with a single block it is NULL
.
block
supplies the main body of the loop, and cont
optionally supplies a continue
block that operates as a second half of the body. All of these optree inputs are consumed by this function and become part of the constructed op tree.
flags
gives the eight bits of op_flags
for the leaveloop
op and, shifted up eight bits, the eight bits of op_private
for the leaveloop
op, except that (in both cases) some bits will be set automatically. debuggable
is currently unused and should always be 1. has_my
can be supplied as true
to force the loop body to be enclosed in its own scope.
OP * newWHILEOP(I32 flags, UNUSED I32 debuggable,
LOOP *loop, OP *expr, OP *block,
OP *cont, I32 has_my)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Available only under threaded builds, this function allocates an entry in PL_stashpad
for the stash passed to it.
PADOFFSET alloccopstash(HV *hv)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Attempts to apply a list of attributes specified by the attrstr
and len
arguments to the subroutine identified by the cv
argument which is expected to be associated with the package identified by the stashpv
argument (see attributes). It gets this wrong, though, in that it does not correctly identify the boundaries of the individual attribute specifications within attrstr
. This is not really intended for the public API, but has to be listed here for systems such as AIX which need an explicit export list for symbols. (It's called from XS code in support of the ATTRS:
keyword from xsubpp.) Patches to fix it to respect attribute syntax properly would be welcome.
void apply_attrs_string(const char *stashpv, CV *cv,
const char *attrstr,
STRLEN len)
Handles compile-time scope exit.
floor
is the savestack index returned by block_start
, and seq
is the body of the block.
Returns the block, possibly modified.
OP * block_end(I32 floor, OP *seq)
Handles compile-time scope entry. Arranges for hints to be restored on block exit and also handles pad sequence numbers to make lexical variables scope right. Returns a savestack index for use with block_end
.
int block_start(int full)
If cv
is a constant sub eligible for inlining, returns the constant value returned by the sub. Otherwise, returns NULL
.
Constant subs can be created with newCONSTSUB
or as described in "Constant Functions" in perlsub.
SV* cv_const_sv(const CV *const cv)
Given the root of an optree, link the tree in execution order using the op_next
pointers and return the first op executed. If this has already been done, it will not be redone, and o->op_next
will be returned. If o->op_next
is not already set, o
should be at least an UNOP
.
OP* LINKLIST(NN OP *o)
Behaves like "newCONSTSUB_flags", except that name
is nul-terminated rather than of counted length, and no flags are set. (This means that name
is always interpreted as Latin-1.)
CV * newCONSTSUB(HV *stash, const char *name, SV *sv)
Construct a constant subroutine, also performing some surrounding jobs. A scalar constant-valued subroutine is eligible for inlining at compile-time, and in Perl code can be created by sub FOO () { 123 }
. Other kinds of constant subroutine have other treatment.
The subroutine will have an empty prototype and will ignore any arguments when called. Its constant behaviour is determined by sv
. If sv
is null, the subroutine will yield an empty list. If sv
points to a scalar, the subroutine will always yield that scalar. If sv
points to an array, the subroutine will always yield a list of the elements of that array in list context, or the number of elements in the array in scalar context. This function takes ownership of one counted reference to the scalar or array, and will arrange for the object to live as long as the subroutine does. If sv
points to a scalar then the inlining assumes that the value of the scalar will never change, so the caller must ensure that the scalar is not subsequently written to. If sv
points to an array then no such assumption is made, so it is ostensibly safe to mutate the array or its elements, but whether this is really supported has not been determined.
The subroutine will have CvFILE
set according to PL_curcop
. Other aspects of the subroutine will be left in their default state. The caller is free to mutate the subroutine beyond its initial state after this function has returned.
If name
is null then the subroutine will be anonymous, with its CvGV
referring to an __ANON__
glob. If name
is non-null then the subroutine will be named accordingly, referenced by the appropriate glob. name
is a string of length len
bytes giving a sigilless symbol name, in UTF-8 if flags
has the SVf_UTF8
bit set and in Latin-1 otherwise. The name may be either qualified or unqualified. If the name is unqualified then it defaults to being in the stash specified by stash
if that is non-null, or to PL_curstash
if stash
is null. The symbol is always added to the stash if necessary, with GV_ADDMULTI
semantics.
flags
for the CV should not have bits set other than SVf_UTF8
or CVf_NODEBUG
for empty imports.
If there is already a subroutine of the specified name, then the new sub will replace the existing one in the glob. A warning may be generated about the redefinition.
If the subroutine has one of a few special names, such as BEGIN
or END
, then it will be claimed by the appropriate queue for automatic running of phase-related subroutines. In this case the relevant glob will be left not containing any subroutine, even if it did contain one before. Execution of the subroutine will likely be a no-op, unless sv
was a tied array or the caller modified the subroutine in some interesting way before it was executed. In the case of BEGIN
, the treatment is buggy: the sub will be executed when only half built, and may be deleted prematurely, possibly causing a crash.
The function returns a pointer to the constructed subroutine. If the sub is anonymous then ownership of one counted reference to the subroutine is transferred to the caller. If the sub is named then the caller does not get ownership of a reference. In most such cases, where the sub has a non-phase name, the sub will be alive at the point it is returned by virtue of being contained in the glob that names it. A phase-named subroutine will usually be alive by virtue of the reference owned by the phase's automatic run queue. A BEGIN
subroutine may have been destroyed already by the time this function returns, but currently bugs occur in that case before the caller gets control. It is the caller's responsibility to ensure that it knows which of these situations applies.
CV * newCONSTSUB_flags(HV *stash, const char *name,
STRLEN len, U32 flags, SV *sv)
Used by xsubpp
to hook up XSUBs as Perl subs. filename
needs to be static storage, as it is used directly as CvFILE(), without a copy being made.
Append an item to the list of ops contained directly within a list-type op, returning the lengthened list. first
is the list-type op, and last
is the op to append to the list. optype
specifies the intended opcode for the list. If first
is not already a list of the right type, it will be upgraded into one. If either first
or last
is null, the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_append_elem(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
Concatenate the lists of ops contained directly within two list-type ops, returning the combined list. first
and last
are the list-type ops to concatenate. optype
specifies the intended opcode for the list. If either first
or last
is not already a list of the right type, it will be upgraded into one. If either first
or last
is null, the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_append_list(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
Return the class of the provided OP: that is, which of the *OP structures it uses. For core ops this currently gets the information out of PL_opargs
, which does not always accurately reflect the type used; in v5.26 onwards, see also the function "op_class"
which can do a better job of determining the used type.
For custom ops the type is returned from the registration, and it is up to the registree to ensure it is accurate. The value returned will be one of the OA_
* constants from op.h.
U32 OP_CLASS(OP *o)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Clones just the op tree/graph, not the data. This is the opposite to cv_clone
, which clones that pads, but not the ops.
Relinks all ops inside this list, but not the ones outside.
In the first pass visit and store all op_next pointers, and store all the locations of the to be fixed up other pointers, in the 2nd pass all pointers inside the graph are known, and fixup the missing other pointers.
init
= TRUE will re-initialize the op cache.
Yes, this function is algorithmicly similar to a Garbage Collector.
Note that when op_clone_oplist is called outside of the first compiler passes, the ops will not be slabbed. The third rpeep pass is already to late.
OP* op_clone_optree(OP* o, bool init)
Applies a syntactic context to an op tree representing an expression. o
is the op tree, and context
must be G_SCALAR
, G_ARRAY
, or G_VOID
to specify the context to apply, i.e. what the lhs side will expect. The modified op tree is returned.
OP * op_contextualize(NN OP *o, I32 context)
Converts o
into a list op if it is not one already, and then converts it into the specified type
, calling its check function, allocating a target if it needs one, and folding constants.
A list-type op is usually constructed one kid at a time via newLISTOP
, op_prepend_elem
and op_append_elem
. Then finally it is passed to op_convert_list
to make it the right type.
OP * op_convert_list(I32 type, I32 flags, OP *o)
Return a short description of the provided OP.
const char * OP_DESC(OP *o)
Free an op. Only use this when an op is no longer linked to from any optree.
void op_free(OP *o)
Returns true if o
has a sibling
bool OpHAS_SIBLING(OP *o)
Marks o
as having no further siblings and marks o as having the specified parent. See also "OpMORESIB_set"
and OpMAYBESIB_set
. For a higher-level interface, see "op_sibling_splice"
.
void OpLASTSIB_set(OP *o, OP *parent)
This function is the implementation of the "LINKLIST" macro.
It is responsible to establish postfix order of the subtree, the kids, linking recursively the next pointers together, depending on the siblings and kids. The head is the exit node, the first kid the start node, the siblings following each other.
The compiler arranges the optree first with empty op_next pointers. If LINKLIST is called on an unempty op it does nothing. LINKLIST sets all the op_next pointers.
The head node must have no op_next pointer, this is the exit condition for the recursion.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
OP* op_linklist(OP *o)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Propagate lvalue ("modifiable") context to an op and its children. type
represents the context type, roughly based on the type of op that would do the modifying, although local()
is represented by OP_NULL
, because it has no op type of its own (it is signalled by a flag on the lvalue op).
This function detects things that can't be modified, such as $x+1
, and generates errors for them. For example, $x+1 = 2
would cause it to be called with an op of type OP_ADD
and a type
argument of OP_SASSIGN
.
It also flags things that need to behave specially in an lvalue context, such as $$x = 5
which might have to vivify a reference in $x
.
OP * op_lvalue(OP *o, I32 type)
Conditionally does OpMORESIB_set
or OpLASTSIB_set
depending on whether sib
is non-null. For a higher-level interface, see "op_sibling_splice"
.
void OpMAYBESIB_set(OP *o, OP *sib, OP *parent)
Sets the sibling of o
to the non-zero value sib
. See also "OpLASTSIB_set"
and "OpMAYBESIB_set"
. For a higher-level interface, see "op_sibling_splice"
.
void OpMORESIB_set(OP *o, OP *sib)
Return the name of the provided OP. For core ops this looks up the name from the op_type; for custom ops from the op_ppaddr.
const char * OP_NAME(OP *o)
Neutralizes an op when it is no longer needed, but is still linked to from other ops.
void op_null(OP *o)
Returns the parent OP of o
, if it has a parent. Returns NULL
otherwise. This function is only available on perls built with -DPERL_OP_PARENT
, which is the default since v5.25.1/v5.25.3c
OP* op_parent(OP *o)
Prepend an item to the list of ops contained directly within a list-type op, returning the lengthened list. first
is the op to prepend to the list, and last
is the list-type op. optype
specifies the intended opcode for the list. If last
is not already a list of the right type, it will be upgraded into one. If either first
or last
is null, the other is returned unchanged.
OP * op_prepend_elem(I32 optype, OP *first, OP *last)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Wraps up an op tree with some additional ops so that at runtime a dynamic scope will be created. The original ops run in the new dynamic scope, and then, provided that they exit normally, the scope will be unwound. The additional ops used to create and unwind the dynamic scope will normally be an enter
/leave
pair, but a scope
op may be used instead if the ops are simple enough to not need the full dynamic scope structure.
OP * op_scope(OP *o)
Returns the sibling of o
, or NULL
if there is no sibling
OP* OpSIBLING(OP *o)
NULLOK OP *parent |NULLOK OP *start |int del_count |NULLOK OP* insert
A general function for editing the structure of an existing chain of op_sibling nodes. By analogy with the perl-level splice()
function, allows you to delete zero or more sequential nodes, replacing them with zero or more different nodes. Performs the necessary op_first/op_last housekeeping on the parent node and op_sibling manipulation on the children. The last deleted node will be marked as as the last node by updating the op_sibling/op_sibparent or op_moresib field as appropriate.
Note that op_next is not manipulated, and nodes are not freed; that is the responsibility of the caller. It also won't create a new list op for an empty list etc; use higher-level functions like op_append_elem() for that.
parent
is the parent node of the sibling chain. It may passed as NULL
if the splicing doesn't affect the first or last op in the chain.
start
is the node preceding the first node to be spliced. Sibling node(s) following it will be deleted, and ops will be inserted after it. If it is NULL
, the first node onwards is deleted, and nodes are inserted at the beginning.
del_count
is the number of sibling nodes to delete. If zero, no nodes are deleted. If -1 or greater than or equal to the number of remaining kids, all remaining kids are deleted.
insert
is the first of a chain of nodes to be inserted in place of the nodes. If NULL
, no nodes are inserted.
The head of the chain of deleted ops is returned, or NULL
if no ops were deleted.
For example:
action before after returns
------ ----- ----- -------
P P
splice(P, A, 2, X-Y-Z) | | B-C
A-B-C-D A-X-Y-Z-D
P P
splice(P, NULL, 1, X-Y) | | A
A-B-C-D X-Y-B-C-D
P P
splice(P, NULL, 3, NULL) | | A-B-C
A-B-C-D D
P P
splice(P, B, 0, X-Y) | | NULL
A-B-C-D A-B-X-Y-C-D
For lower-level direct manipulation of op_sibparent
and op_moresib
, see "OpMORESIB_set"
, "OpLASTSIB_set"
, "OpMAYBESIB_set"
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
OP* op_sibling_splice
Returns true if the given OP is not a NULL
pointer and if it is of the given type.
The negation of this macro, OP_TYPE_ISNT
is also available as well as OP_TYPE_IS_NN
and OP_TYPE_ISNT_NN
which elide the NULL pointer check.
bool OP_TYPE_IS(OP *o, Optype type)
Returns true if the given OP is not a NULL pointer and if it is of the given type or used to be before being replaced by an OP of type OP_NULL.
The negation of this macro, OP_TYPE_ISNT_AND_WASNT
is also available as well as OP_TYPE_IS_OR_WAS_NN
and OP_TYPE_ISNT_AND_WASNT_NN
which elide the NULL
pointer check.
bool OP_TYPE_IS_OR_WAS(OP *o, Optype type)
Sets ref context for the op, i.e. marks the op as modifying via OPf_MOD, or OPf_REF for references.
OP* ref(OP* o, I32 type)
The engine implementing pack()
Perl function.
void packlist(SV *cat, const char *pat,
const char *patend, SV **beglist,
SV **endlist)
The engine implementing the unpack()
Perl function.
Using the template pat..patend
, this function unpacks the string s..strend
into a number of mortal SVs, which it pushes onto the perl argument (@_
) stack (so you will need to issue a PUTBACK
before and SPAGAIN
after the call to this function). It returns the number of pushed elements.
The strend
and patend
pointers should point to the byte following the last character of each string.
Although this function returns its values on the perl argument stack, it doesn't take any parameters from that stack (and thus in particular there's no need to do a PUSHMARK
before calling it, unlike "call_pv" for example).
SSize_t unpackstring(const char *pat,
const char *patend, const char *s,
const char *strend, U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
CV's can have CvPADLIST(cv) set to point to a PADLIST. This is the CV's scratchpad, which stores lexical variables and opcode temporary and per-thread values.
For these purposes "formats" are a kind-of CV; eval""s are too (except they're not callable at will and are always thrown away after the eval"" is done executing). Require'd files are simply evals without any outer lexical scope.
XSUBs do not have a CvPADLIST
. dXSTARG
fetches values from PL_curpad
, but that is really the callers pad (a slot of which is allocated by every entersub). Do not get or set CvPADLIST
if a CV is an XSUB (as determined by CvISXSUB()
), CvPADLIST
slot is reused for a different internal purpose in XSUBs.
The PADLIST has a C array where pads are stored.
The 0th entry of the PADLIST is a PADNAMELIST which represents the "names" or rather the "static type information" for lexicals. The individual elements of a PADNAMELIST are PADNAMEs. Future refactorings might stop the PADNAMELIST from being stored in the PADLIST's array, so don't rely on it. See "PadlistNAMES".
The CvDEPTH'th entry of a PADLIST is a PAD (an AV) which is the stack frame at that depth of recursion into the CV. The 0-th slot of a frame AV is an AV which is @_
. Other entries are storage for variables and op targets.
Iterating over the PADNAMELIST iterates over all possible pad items. Pad slots for targets (SVs_PADTMP
) and GVs end up having &PL_padname_undef
"names", while slots for constants have &PL_padname_const
"names" (see "pad_alloc"
). That &PL_padname_undef
and &PL_padname_const
are used is an implementation detail subject to change. To test for them, use !PadnamePV(name)
and PadnamePV(name) && !PadnameLEN(name)
, respectively.
Only lexical variable slots get valid names (i.e. my/our/state/has, signature variables). The rest are op targets/GVs/constants which are statically allocated or resolved at compile time. These don't have names by which they can be looked up from Perl code at run time through eval"" the way lexical variables can be. Since they can't be looked up by "name" but only by their index allocated at compile time (which is usually in PL_op->op_targ
), wasting a name SV for them doesn't make sense.
The pad names in the PADNAMELIST have their PV holding the name of the variable. The COP_SEQ_RANGE_LOW
and _HIGH
fields form a range (low+1..high inclusive) of cop_seq numbers for which the name is valid. During compilation, these fields may hold the special value PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO to indicate various stages:
COP_SEQ_RANGE_LOW _HIGH
----------------- -----
PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO 0 variable not yet introduced:
{ my ($x
valid-seq# PERL_PADSEQ_INTRO variable in scope:
{ my ($x);
valid-seq# valid-seq# compilation of scope complete:
{ my ($x); .... }
When a lexical var hasn't yet been introduced, it already exists from the perspective of duplicate declarations, but not for variable lookups, e.g.
my ($x, $x); # '"my" variable $x masks earlier declaration'
my $x = $x; # equal to my $x = $::x;
For typed lexicals PadnameTYPE
points at the type stash. For our
lexicals, PadnameOURSTASH
points at the stash of the associated global (so that duplicate our
declarations in the same package can be detected). PadnameGEN
is sometimes used to store the generation number during compilation.
If PadnameOUTER
is set on the pad name, then that slot in the frame AV is a REFCNT'ed reference to a lexical from "outside". Such entries are sometimes referred to as 'fake'. In this case, the name does not use 'low' and 'high' to store a cop_seq range, since it is in scope throughout. Instead 'high' stores some flags containing info about the real lexical (is it declared in an anon, and is it capable of being instantiated multiple times?), and for fake ANONs, 'low' contains the index within the parent's pad where the lexical's value is stored, to make cloning quicker.
If the 'name' is &
the corresponding entry in the PAD is a CV representing a possible closure.
Note that formats are treated as anon subs, and are cloned each time write is called (if necessary).
The flag SVs_PADSTALE
is cleared on lexicals each time the my()
is executed, and set on scope exit. This allows the "Variable $x is not available"
warning to be generated in evals, such as
{ my $x = 1; sub f { eval '$x'} } f();
For state vars, SVs_PADSTALE
is overloaded to mean 'not yet initialised', but this internal state is stored in a separate pad entry.
PADLIST * CvPADLIST(CV *cv)
Exactly like "pad_add_name_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_add_name_pvs("literal string" name,
U32 flags, HV *typestash,
HV *ourstash)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The C array of pad entries.
SV ** PadARRAY(PAD pad)
Exactly like "pad_findmy_pvn", but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
PADOFFSET pad_findmy_pvs("literal string" name,
U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The C array of a padlist, containing the pads. Only subscript it with numbers >= 1, as the 0th entry is not guaranteed to remain usable.
PAD ** PadlistARRAY(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The index of the last allocated space in the padlist. Note that the last pad may be in an earlier slot. Any entries following it will be NULL
in that case.
SSize_t PadlistMAX(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The names associated with pad entries.
PADNAMELIST * PadlistNAMES(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The C array of pad names.
PADNAME ** PadlistNAMESARRAY(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The index of the last pad name.
SSize_t PadlistNAMESMAX(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The reference count of the padlist. Currently this is always 1.
U32 PadlistREFCNT(PADLIST padlist)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The index of the last pad entry.
SSize_t PadMAX(PAD pad)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The length of the name.
STRLEN PadnameLEN(PADNAME pn)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The C array of pad names.
PADNAME ** PadnamelistARRAY(PADNAMELIST pnl)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The index of the last pad name.
SSize_t PadnamelistMAX(PADNAMELIST pnl)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The reference count of the pad name list.
SSize_t PadnamelistREFCNT(PADNAMELIST pnl)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Lowers the reference count of the pad name list.
void PadnamelistREFCNT_dec(PADNAMELIST pnl)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The name stored in the pad name struct. This returns NULL
for a target slot.
char * PadnamePV(PADNAME pn)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
The reference count of the pad name.
SSize_t PadnameREFCNT(PADNAME pn)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Lowers the reference count of the pad name.
void PadnameREFCNT_dec(PADNAME pn)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Returns the pad name as a mortal SV.
SV * PadnameSV(PADNAME pn)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Whether PadnamePV is UTF-8. For non-cperl this returns always 1
.
bool PadnameUTF8(PADNAME pn)
Create a new padlist, updating the global variables for the currently-compiling padlist to point to the new padlist. The following flags can be OR'ed together:
padnew_CLONE this pad is for a cloned CV
padnew_SAVE save old globals on the save stack
padnew_SAVESUB also save extra stuff for start of sub
PADLIST * pad_new(int flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
During compilation, this points to the array containing the values part of the pad for the currently-compiling code. (At runtime a CV may have many such value arrays; at compile time just one is constructed.) At runtime, this points to the array containing the currently-relevant values for the pad for the currently-executing code.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
During compilation, this points to the array containing the names part of the pad for the currently-compiling code.
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Points directly to the body of the "PL_comppad" array. (I.e., this is PadARRAY(PL_comppad)
.)
PL_modglobal
is a general purpose, interpreter global HV for use by extensions that need to keep information on a per-interpreter basis. In a pinch, it can also be used as a symbol table for extensions to share data among each other. It is a good idea to use keys prefixed by the package name of the extension that owns the data.
HV* PL_modglobal
A convenience variable which is typically used with SvPV
when one doesn't care about the length of the string. It is usually more efficient to either declare a local variable and use that instead or to use the SvPV_nolen
macro.
STRLEN PL_na
When non-NULL
, the function pointed by this variable will be called each time an OP is freed with the corresponding OP as the argument. This allows extensions to free any extra attribute they have locally attached to an OP. It is also assured to first fire for the parent OP and then for its kids.
When you replace this variable, it is considered a good practice to store the possibly previously installed hook and that you recall it inside your own.
Perl_ophook_t PL_opfreehook
Pointer to the per-subroutine peephole optimiser. This is a function that gets called at the end of compilation of a Perl subroutine (or equivalently independent piece of Perl code) to perform fixups of some ops and to perform small-scale optimisations. The function is called once for each subroutine that is compiled, and is passed, as sole parameter, a pointer to the op that is the entry point to the subroutine. It modifies the op tree in place.
The peephole optimiser should never be completely replaced. Rather, add code to it by wrapping the existing optimiser. The basic way to do this can be seen in "Compile pass 3: peephole optimization" in perlguts. If the new code wishes to operate on ops throughout the subroutine's structure, rather than just at the top level, it is likely to be more convenient to wrap the "PL_rpeepp" hook.
peep_t PL_peepp
Pointer to the recursive peephole optimiser. This is a function that gets called at the end of compilation of a Perl subroutine (or equivalently independent piece of Perl code) to perform fixups of some ops and to perform small-scale optimisations. The function is called once for each chain of ops linked through their op_next
fields; it is recursively called to handle each side chain. It is passed, as sole parameter, a pointer to the op that is at the head of the chain. It modifies the op tree in place.
The peephole optimiser should never be completely replaced. Rather, add code to it by wrapping the existing optimiser. The basic way to do this can be seen in "Compile pass 3: peephole optimization" in perlguts. If the new code wishes to operate only on ops at a subroutine's top level, rather than throughout the structure, it is likely to be more convenient to wrap the "PL_peepp" hook.
peep_t PL_rpeepp
This is the false
SV. See "PL_sv_yes"
. Always refer to this as &PL_sv_no
or SV_NO
.
SV PL_sv_no
This is the undef
SV. Always refer to this as &PL_sv_undef
.
SV PL_sv_undef
This is the true
SV. See "PL_sv_no"
. Always refer to this as &PL_sv_yes
or SV_YES
.
SV PL_sv_yes
This readonly SV has a zero numeric value and a "0"
string value. It's similar to "PL_sv_no"
except for its string value. Can be used as a cheap alternative to mXPUSHi(0)
for example. Always refer to this as &PL_sv_zero
or SV_ZERO
. Introduced in 5.28.
SV PL_sv_zero
Convenience macro to get the REGEXP from a SV. This is approximately equivalent to the following snippet:
if (SvMAGICAL(sv))
mg_get(sv);
if (SvROK(sv))
sv = MUTABLE_SV(SvRV(sv));
if (SvTYPE(sv) == SVt_REGEXP)
return (REGEXP*) sv;
NULL
will be returned if a REGEXP* is not found.
REGEXP * SvRX(SV *sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV (or the one it references) is a REGEXP.
If you want to do something with the REGEXP* later use SvRX instead and check for NULL.
bool SvRXOK(SV* sv)
Declare a stack marker variable, mark
, for the XSUB. See "MARK"
and "dORIGMARK"
.
dMARK;
Saves the original stack mark for the XSUB. See "ORIGMARK"
.
dORIGMARK;
Declares a local copy of perl's stack pointer for the XSUB, available via the SP
macro. See "SP"
.
dSP;
Used to extend the argument stack for an XSUB's return values. Once used, guarantees that there is room for at least nitems
to be pushed onto the stack.
void EXTEND(SP, SSize_t nitems)
Stack marker variable for the XSUB. See "dMARK"
.
Push an integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHi"
, "mXPUSHi"
and "XPUSHi"
.
void mPUSHi(IV iv)
Push a double onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHn"
, "mXPUSHn"
and "XPUSHn"
.
void mPUSHn(NV nv)
Push a string onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. The len
indicates the length of the string. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHp"
, "mXPUSHp"
and "XPUSHp"
.
void mPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
Push an SV onto the stack and mortalizes the SV. The stack must have room for this element. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHs"
and "mXPUSHs"
.
void mPUSHs(SV* sv)
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHu"
, "mXPUSHu"
and "XPUSHu"
.
void mPUSHu(UV uv)
Push an integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHi"
, "mPUSHi"
and "PUSHi"
.
void mXPUSHi(IV iv)
Push a double onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHn"
, "mPUSHn"
and "PUSHn"
.
void mXPUSHn(NV nv)
Push a string onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. The len
indicates the length of the string. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHp"
, mPUSHp
and PUSHp
.
void mXPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
Push an SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary and mortalizes the SV. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHs"
and "mPUSHs"
.
void mXPUSHs(SV* sv)
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHu"
, "mPUSHu"
and "PUSHu"
.
void mXPUSHu(UV uv)
The original stack mark for the XSUB. See "dORIGMARK"
.
Pops an integer off the stack.
IV POPi
Pops a long off the stack.
long POPl
Pops a double off the stack.
NV POPn
Pops a string off the stack.
char* POPp
Pops a string off the stack which must consist of bytes i.e. characters < 256.
char* POPpbytex
Pops a string off the stack. Identical to POPp. There are two names for historical reasons.
char* POPpx
Pops an SV off the stack.
SV* POPs
Pops an unsigned integer off the stack.
UV POPu
Pops an unsigned long off the stack.
long POPul
Push an integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHi"
instead. See also "XPUSHi"
and "mXPUSHi"
.
void PUSHi(IV iv)
Opening bracket for arguments on a callback. See "PUTBACK"
and perlcall.
void PUSHMARK(SP)
Push a new mortal SV onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHs"
, "XPUSHmortal"
and "XPUSHs"
.
void PUSHmortal()
Push a double onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHn"
instead. See also "XPUSHn"
and "mXPUSHn"
.
void PUSHn(NV nv)
Push a string onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. The len
indicates the length of the string. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHp"
instead. See also "XPUSHp"
and "mXPUSHp"
.
void PUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
Push an SV onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Does not handle 'set' magic. Does not use TARG
. See also "PUSHmortal"
, "XPUSHs"
, and "XPUSHmortal"
.
void PUSHs(SV* sv)
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack. The stack must have room for this element. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mPUSHu"
instead. See also "XPUSHu"
and "mXPUSHu"
.
void PUSHu(UV uv)
Closing bracket for XSUB arguments. This is usually handled by xsubpp
. See "PUSHMARK"
and perlcall for other uses.
PUTBACK;
Stack pointer. This is usually handled by xsubpp
. See "dSP"
and SPAGAIN
.
Refetch the stack pointer. Used after a callback. See perlcall.
SPAGAIN;
Push an integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHi"
instead. See also "PUSHi"
and "mPUSHi"
.
void XPUSHi(IV iv)
Push a new mortal SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHs"
, "PUSHmortal"
and "PUSHs"
.
void XPUSHmortal()
Push a double onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHn"
instead. See also "PUSHn"
and "mPUSHn"
.
void XPUSHn(NV nv)
Push a string onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. The len
indicates the length of the string. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHp"
instead. See also "PUSHp"
and "mPUSHp"
.
void XPUSHp(char* str, STRLEN len)
Push an SV onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Does not handle 'set' magic. Does not use TARG
. See also "XPUSHmortal"
, PUSHs
and PUSHmortal
.
void XPUSHs(SV* sv)
Push an unsigned integer onto the stack, extending the stack if necessary. Handles 'set' magic. Uses TARG
, so dTARGET
or dXSTARG
should be called to declare it. Do not call multiple TARG
-oriented macros to return lists from XSUB's - see "mXPUSHu"
instead. See also "PUSHu"
and "mPUSHu"
.
void XPUSHu(UV uv)
Return from XSUB, indicating number of items on the stack. This is usually handled by xsubpp
.
void XSRETURN(int nitems)
Return an empty list from an XSUB immediately.
XSRETURN_EMPTY;
Return an integer from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mIV
.
void XSRETURN_IV(IV iv)
Return SV_NO
from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mNO
.
XSRETURN_NO;
Return a double from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mNV
.
void XSRETURN_NV(NV nv)
Return a copy of a string from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mPV
.
void XSRETURN_PV(char* str)
Return &PL_sv_undef
from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mUNDEF
.
XSRETURN_UNDEF;
Return an integer from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mUV
.
void XSRETURN_UV(IV uv)
Return SV_YES
from an XSUB immediately. Uses XST_mYES
.
XSRETURN_YES;
Place an integer into the specified position pos
on the stack. The value is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mIV(int pos, IV iv)
Place SV_NO
into the specified position pos
on the stack.
void XST_mNO(int pos)
Place a double into the specified position pos
on the stack. The value is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mNV(int pos, NV nv)
Place a copy of a string into the specified position pos
on the stack. The value is stored in a new mortal SV.
void XST_mPV(int pos, char* str)
Place &PL_sv_undef
into the specified position pos
on the stack.
void XST_mUNDEF(int pos)
Place SV_YES
into the specified position pos
on the stack.
void XST_mYES(int pos)
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for arrays. See "svtype".
Type flag for subroutines. See "svtype".
Type flag for formats. See "svtype".
Type flag for typeglobs. See "svtype".
Type flag for hashes. See "svtype".
Type flag for I/O objects. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for scalars. See "svtype".
Type flag for regular expressions. See "svtype".
An enum of flags for Perl types. These are found in the file sv.h in the svtype
enum. Test these flags with the SvTYPE
macro.
The types are:
SVt_NULL
SVt_IV
SVt_NV
SVt_RV
SVt_PV
SVt_PVIV
SVt_PVNV
SVt_PVMG
SVt_INVLIST
SVt_REGEXP
SVt_PVGV
SVt_PVLV
SVt_PVAV
SVt_PVHV
SVt_PVCV
SVt_PVFM
SVt_PVIO
These are most easily explained from the bottom up.
SVt_PVIO
is for I/O objects, SVt_PVFM
for formats, SVt_PVCV
for subroutines, SVt_PVHV
for hashes and SVt_PVAV
for arrays.
All the others are scalar types, that is, things that can be bound to a $
variable. For these, the internal types are mostly orthogonal to types in the Perl language.
Hence, checking SvTYPE(sv) < SVt_PVAV
is the best way to see whether something is a scalar.
SVt_PVGV
represents a typeglob. If !SvFAKE(sv)
, then it is a real, incoercible typeglob. If SvFAKE(sv)
, then it is a scalar to which a typeglob has been assigned. Assigning to it again will stop it from being a typeglob. SVt_PVLV
represents a scalar that delegates to another scalar behind the scenes. It is used, e.g., for the return value of substr
and for tied hash and array elements. It can hold any scalar value, including a typeglob. SVt_REGEXP
is for regular expressions. SVt_INVLIST
is for Perl core internal use only.
SVt_PVMG
represents a "normal" scalar (not a typeglob, regular expression, or delegate). Since most scalars do not need all the internal fields of a PVMG, we save memory by allocating smaller structs when possible. All the other types are just simpler forms of SVt_PVMG
, with fewer internal fields. SVt_NULL
can only hold undef. SVt_IV
can hold undef, an integer, or a reference. (SVt_RV
is an alias for SVt_IV
, which exists for backward compatibility.) SVt_NV
can hold any of those or a double. SVt_PV
can only hold undef
or a string. SVt_PVIV
is a superset of SVt_PV
and SVt_IV
. SVt_PVNV
is similar. SVt_PVMG
can hold anything SVt_PVNV
can hold, but it can, but does not have to, be blessed or magical.
Returns a true SV if b
is a true value, or a false SV if b
is 0.
See also "PL_sv_yes"
and "PL_sv_no"
.
SV * boolSV(bool b)
A specialised variant of croak()
for emitting the usage message for xsubs
croak_xs_usage(cv, "eee_yow");
works out the package name and subroutine name from cv
, and then calls croak()
. Hence if cv
is &ouch::awk
, it would call croak
as:
Perl_croak(aTHX_ "Usage: %" SVf "::%" SVf "(%s)", "ouch" "awk",
"eee_yow");
void croak_xs_usage(const CV *const cv,
const char *const params)
Uses strlen
to get the length of name
, then calls get_svn_flags
.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* get_sv(const char *name, I32 flags)
Returns the SV of the specified Perl scalar. flags
are passed to gv_fetchpv
. If GV_ADD
is set and the Perl variable does not exist then it will be created. If flags
is zero and the variable does not exist then NULL is returned.
In cperl only.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* get_svn_flags(const char* name, STRLEN len,
I32 flags)
get_svs("Name", flags)
to be used with a constant string.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
SV* get_svs(const char *name, I32 flags)
Test if the content of an SV looks like a number (or is a number). Inf
and Infinity
are treated as numbers (so will not issue a non-numeric warning), even if your atof()
doesn't grok them. Get-magic is ignored.
I32 looks_like_number(SV *const sv)
Creates an RV wrapper for an SV. The reference count for the original SV is incremented.
SV* newRV_inc(SV* sv)
Creates an RV wrapper for an SV. The reference count for the original SV is not incremented.
SV* newRV_noinc(SV *const tmpRef)
Creates a new SV. A non-zero len
parameter indicates the number of bytes of preallocated string space the SV should have. An extra byte for a trailing NUL
is also reserved. (SvPOK
is not set for the SV even if string space is allocated.) The reference count for the new SV is set to 1.
In 5.9.3, newSV()
replaces the older NEWSV()
API, and drops the first parameter, x, a debug aid which allowed callers to identify themselves. This aid has been superseded by a new build option, PERL_MEM_LOG
(see "PERL_MEM_LOG" in perlhacktips). The older API is still there for use in XS modules supporting older perls.
SV* newSV(const STRLEN len)
Creates a new SV from the hash key structure. It will generate scalars that point to the shared string table where possible. Returns a new (undefined) SV if hek
is NULL.
SV* newSVhek(const HEK *const hek)
Creates a new SV and copies an integer into it. The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
SV* newSViv(const IV i)
Creates a new SV and copies a floating point value into it. The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
SV* newSVnv(const NV n)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Creates a new SV containing the pad name.
SV* newSVpadname(PADNAME *pn)
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain NUL
(\0
) characters) into it. The reference count for the SV is set to 1. If len
is zero, Perl will compute the length using strlen()
, (which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte).
This function can cause reliability issues if you are likely to pass in empty strings that are not null terminated, because it will run strlen on the string and potentially run past valid memory.
Using "newSVpvn" is a safer alternative for non NUL
terminated strings. For string literals use "newSVpvs" instead. This function will work fine for NUL
terminated strings, but if you want to avoid the if statement on whether to call strlen
use newSVpvn
instead (calling strlen
yourself).
SV* newSVpv(const char *const s, const STRLEN len)
Creates a new SV and initializes it with the string formatted like sv_catpvf
.
SV* newSVpvf(const char *const pat, ...)
Creates a new SV and copies a string into it, which may contain NUL
characters (\0
) and other binary data. The reference count for the SV is set to 1. Note that if len
is zero, Perl will create a zero length (Perl) string. You are responsible for ensuring that the source buffer is at least len
bytes long. If the buffer
argument is NULL the new SV will be undefined.
SV* newSVpvn(const char *const buffer,
const STRLEN len)
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain NUL
(\0
) characters) into it. The reference count for the SV is set to 1. Note that if len
is zero, Perl will create a zero length string. You are responsible for ensuring that the source string is at least len
bytes long. If the s
argument is NULL the new SV will be undefined. Currently the only flag bits accepted are SVf_UTF8
and SVs_TEMP
. If SVs_TEMP
is set, then sv_2mortal()
is called on the result before returning. If SVf_UTF8
is set, s
is considered to be in UTF-8 and the SVf_UTF8
flag will be set on the new SV. newSVpvn_utf8()
is a convenience wrapper for this function, defined as
#define newSVpvn_utf8(s, len, u) \
newSVpvn_flags((s), (len), (u) ? SVf_UTF8 : 0)
SV* newSVpvn_flags(const char *const s,
const STRLEN len,
const U32 flags)
Creates a new SV with its SvPVX_const
pointing to a shared string in the string table. If the string does not already exist in the table, it is created first. Turns on the SvIsCOW
flag (or READONLY
and FAKE
in 5.16 and earlier). If the hash
parameter is non-zero, that value is used; otherwise the hash is computed. The string's hash can later be retrieved from the SV with the SvSHARED_HASH()
macro. The idea here is that as the string table is used for shared hash keys these strings will have SvPVX_const == HeKEY
and hash lookup will avoid string compare.
For utf8 strings under 255 the string is downgraded, the utf8 flag is lost and converted to HEK_WASUTF8.
SV* newSVpvn_share(const char* s, I32 len, U32 hash)
Creates a new SV and copies a string (which may contain NUL
(\0
) characters) into it. If utf8
is true, calls SvUTF8_on
on the new SV. Implemented as a wrapper around newSVpvn_flags
.
SV* newSVpvn_utf8(NULLOK const char* s, STRLEN len,
U32 utf8)
Like newSVpvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
SV* newSVpvs("literal string" s)
Like newSVpvn_flags
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
SV* newSVpvs_flags("literal string" s, U32 flags)
Like newSVpvn_share
, but takes a NUL
-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
SV* newSVpv_share(const char* s, U32 hash)
Like newSVpvn_share
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair and omits the hash parameter.
SV* newSVpvs_share("literal string" s)
Creates a new SV for the existing RV, rv
, to point to. If rv
is not an RV then it will be upgraded to one. If classname
is non-null then the new SV will be blessed in the specified package. The new SV is returned and its reference count is 1. The reference count 1 is owned by rv
. See also newRV_inc() and newRV_noinc() for creating a new RV properly.
SV* newSVrv(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname)
Creates a new SV which is an exact duplicate of the original SV. (Uses sv_setsv
.)
SV* newSVsv(SV *const old)
Creates a new SV, of the type specified. The reference count for the new SV is set to 1.
SV* newSV_type(const svtype type)
Creates a new SV and copies an unsigned integer into it. The reference count for the SV is set to 1.
SV* newSVuv(const UV u)
This macro is only used by sv_true()
or its macro equivalent, and only if the latter's argument is neither SvPOK
, SvIOK
nor SvNOK
. It calls sv_2bool_flags
with the SV_GMAGIC
flag.
bool sv_2bool(SV *const sv)
This function is only used by sv_true()
and friends, and only if the latter's argument is neither SvPOK
, SvIOK
nor SvNOK
. If the flags contain SV_GMAGIC
, then it does an mg_get()
first.
bool sv_2bool_flags(SV *sv, I32 flags)
Using various gambits, try to get a CV from an SV; in addition, try if possible to set *st
and *gvp
to the stash and GV associated with it. The flags in lref
are passed to gv_fetchsv
.
CV* sv_2cv(SV* sv, HV **const st, GV **const gvp,
const I32 lref)
Using various gambits, try to get an IO from an SV: the IO slot if its a GV; or the recursive result if we're an RV; or the IO slot of the symbol named after the PV if we're a string.
'Get' magic is ignored on the sv
passed in, but will be called on SvRV(sv)
if sv
is an RV.
IO* sv_2io(SV *const sv)
Return the integer value of an SV, doing any necessary string conversion. If flags
has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, does an mg_get()
first. Normally used via the SvIV(sv)
and SvIVx(sv)
macros.
IV sv_2iv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
Marks an existing SV as mortal. The SV will be destroyed "soon", either by an explicit call to FREETMPS
, or by an implicit call at places such as statement boundaries. SvTEMP()
is turned on which means that the SV's string buffer can be "stolen" if this SV is copied. See also "sv_newmortal"
and "sv_mortalcopy"
.
SV* sv_2mortal(SV *const sv)
Return the num value of an SV, doing any necessary string or integer conversion. If flags
has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, does an mg_get()
first. Normally used via the SvNV(sv)
and SvNVx(sv)
macros.
NV sv_2nv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
Return a pointer to the byte-encoded representation of the SV, and set *lp
to its length. May cause the SV to be downgraded from UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the SvPVbyte
macro.
char* sv_2pvbyte(SV *sv, STRLEN *const lp)
Return a pointer to the UTF-8-encoded representation of the SV, and set *lp
to its length. May cause the SV to be upgraded to UTF-8 as a side-effect.
Usually accessed via the SvPVutf8
macro.
char* sv_2pvutf8(SV *sv, STRLEN *const lp)
Returns a pointer to the string value of an SV, and sets *lp
to its length. If flags has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, does an mg_get()
first. Coerces sv
to a string if necessary. Normally invoked via the SvPV_flags
macro. sv_2pv()
and sv_2pv_nomg
usually end up here too.
char* sv_2pv_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp,
const I32 flags)
Return the unsigned integer value of an SV, doing any necessary string conversion. If flags
has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, does an mg_get()
first. Normally used via the SvUV(sv)
and SvUVx(sv)
macros.
UV sv_2uv_flags(SV *const sv, const I32 flags)
Remove any string offset. You should normally use the SvOOK_off
macro wrapper instead.
void sv_backoff(SV *const sv)
Blesses an SV into a specified package. The SV must be an RV. The package must be designated by its stash (see "gv_stashpv"
). The reference count of the SV is unaffected.
SV* sv_bless(SV *const sv, HV *const stash)
Concatenates the NUL
-terminated string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. If the SV has the UTF-8 status set, then the bytes appended should be valid UTF-8. Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See "sv_catpv_mg"
.
void sv_catpv(SV *const sv, const char* ptr)
Processes its arguments like sprintf
, and appends the formatted output to an SV. As with sv_vcatpvfn
called with a non-null C-style variable argument list, argument reordering is not supported. If the appended data contains "wide" characters (including, but not limited to, SVs with a UTF-8 PV formatted with %s
, and characters >255 formatted with %c
), the original SV might get upgraded to UTF-8. Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See "sv_catpvf_mg"
. If the original SV was UTF-8, the pattern should be valid UTF-8; if the original SV was bytes, the pattern should be too.
void sv_catpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
...)
Like sv_catpvf
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpvf_mg(SV *const sv,
const char *const pat, ...)
Concatenates the string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. len
indicates number of bytes to copy. If the SV has the UTF-8 status set, then the bytes appended should be valid UTF-8. Handles 'get' magic, but not 'set' magic. See "sv_catpvn_mg"
.
void sv_catpvn(SV *dsv, const char *sstr, STRLEN len)
Concatenates the string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. The len
indicates number of bytes to copy.
By default, the string appended is assumed to be valid UTF-8 if the SV has the UTF-8 status set, and a string of bytes otherwise. One can force the appended string to be interpreted as UTF-8 by supplying the SV_CATUTF8
flag, and as bytes by supplying the SV_CATBYTES
flag; the SV or the string appended will be upgraded to UTF-8 if necessary.
If flags
has the SV_SMAGIC
bit set, will mg_set
on dsv
afterwards if appropriate. sv_catpvn
and sv_catpvn_nomg
are implemented in terms of this function.
void sv_catpvn_flags(SV *const dstr,
const char *sstr,
const STRLEN len,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_catpvn
but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catpvn_nomg(SV* sv, const char* ptr,
STRLEN len)
Like sv_catpvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs(SV* sv, "literal string" s)
Like sv_catpvn_flags
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_flags(SV* sv, "literal string" s,
I32 flags)
Like sv_catpvn_mg
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_mg(SV* sv, "literal string" s)
Like sv_catpvn_nomg
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_catpvs_nomg(SV* sv, "literal string" s)
Concatenates the NUL
-terminated string onto the end of the string which is in the SV. If the SV has the UTF-8 status set, then the bytes appended should be valid UTF-8. If flags
has the SV_SMAGIC
bit set, will mg_set
on the modified SV if appropriate.
void sv_catpv_flags(SV *dstr, const char *sstr,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_catpv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_catpv_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
Like sv_catpv
but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catpv_nomg(SV* sv, const char* ptr)
Concatenates the string from SV ssv
onto the end of the string in SV dsv
. If ssv
is null, does nothing; otherwise modifies only dsv
. Handles 'get' magic on both SVs, but no 'set' magic. See "sv_catsv_mg"
and "sv_catsv_nomg"
.
void sv_catsv(SV *dstr, SV *sstr)
Concatenates the string from SV ssv
onto the end of the string in SV dsv
. If ssv
is null, does nothing; otherwise modifies only dsv
. If flags
has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, will call mg_get
on both SVs if appropriate. If flags
has the SV_SMAGIC
bit set, mg_set
will be called on the modified SV afterward, if appropriate. sv_catsv
, sv_catsv_nomg
, and sv_catsv_mg
are implemented in terms of this function.
void sv_catsv_flags(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_catsv
but doesn't process magic.
void sv_catsv_nomg(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Efficient removal of characters from the beginning of the string buffer. SvPOK(sv)
, or at least SvPOKp(sv)
, must be true and ptr
must be a pointer to somewhere inside the string buffer. ptr
becomes the first character of the adjusted string. Uses the OOK
hack. On return, only SvPOK(sv)
and SvPOKp(sv)
among the OK
flags will be true.
Beware: after this function returns, ptr
and SvPVX_const(sv) may no longer refer to the same chunk of data.
The unfortunate similarity of this function's name to that of Perl's chop
operator is strictly coincidental. This function works from the left; chop
works from the right.
void sv_chop(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
Attempt to destroy all objects not yet freed.
void sv_clean_objs()
Clear an SV: call any destructors, free up any memory used by the body, and free the body itself. The SV's head is not freed, although its type is set to all 1's so that it won't inadvertently be assumed to be live during global destruction etc. This function should only be called when REFCNT
is zero. Most of the time you'll want to call sv_free()
(or its macro wrapper SvREFCNT_dec
) instead.
void sv_clear(SV *const orig_sv)
Compares the strings in two SVs. Returns -1, 0, or 1 indicating whether the string in sv1
is less than, equal to, or greater than the string in sv2
. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware, handles get magic, and will coerce its args to strings if necessary. See also "sv_cmp_locale"
.
I32 sv_cmp(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2)
Compares the strings in two SVs. Returns -1, 0, or 1 indicating whether the string in sv1
is less than, equal to, or greater than the string in sv2
. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware and will coerce its args to strings if necessary. If the flags has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, it handles get magic. See also "sv_cmp_locale_flags"
.
I32 sv_cmp_flags(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2,
const U32 flags)
Compares the strings in two SVs in a locale-aware manner. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware, handles get magic, and will coerce its args to strings if necessary. See also "sv_cmp"
.
I32 sv_cmp_locale(SV *const sv1, SV *const sv2)
Compares the strings in two SVs in a locale-aware manner. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware and will coerce its args to strings if necessary. If the flags contain SV_GMAGIC
, it handles get magic. See also "sv_cmp_flags"
.
I32 sv_cmp_locale_flags(SV *const sv1,
SV *const sv2,
const U32 flags)
This calls sv_collxfrm_flags
with the SV_GMAGIC flag. See "sv_collxfrm_flags"
.
char* sv_collxfrm(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const nxp)
Add Collate Transform magic to an SV if it doesn't already have it. If the flags contain SV_GMAGIC
, it handles get-magic.
Any scalar variable may carry PERL_MAGIC_collxfrm
magic that contains the scalar data of the variable, but transformed to such a format that a normal memory comparison can be used to compare the data according to the locale settings.
char* sv_collxfrm_flags(SV *const sv,
STRLEN *const nxp,
I32 const flags)
Copies a stringified representation of the source SV into the destination SV. Automatically performs any necessary mg_get
and coercion of numeric values into strings. Guaranteed to preserve UTF8
flag even from overloaded objects. Similar in nature to sv_2pv[_flags]
but operates directly on an SV instead of just the string. Mostly uses sv_2pv_flags
to do its work, except when that would lose the UTF-8'ness of the PV.
void sv_copypv(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv)
Implementation of sv_copypv
and sv_copypv_nomg
. Calls get magic iff flags has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set.
void sv_copypv_flags(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_copypv
, but doesn't invoke get magic first.
void sv_copypv_nomg(SV *const dsv, SV *const ssv)
Returns the length of the string which is in the SV. See "SvLEN"
.
STRLEN SvCUR(SV* sv)
Set the current length of the string in the SV. See "SvCUR"
and "SvIV_set"
.
void SvCUR_set(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Auto-decrement of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion if necessary. Handles 'get' magic and operator overloading.
void sv_dec(SV *const sv)
Auto-decrement of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion if necessary. Handles operator overloading. Skips handling 'get' magic.
void sv_dec_nomg(SV *const sv)
Exactly like "sv_derived_from_pv", but doesn't take a flags
parameter.
bool sv_derived_from(SV* sv, const char *const name)
Exactly like "sv_derived_from_pvn", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of a string/length pair.
bool sv_derived_from_pv(SV* sv,
const char *const name,
U32 flags)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is derived from the specified class at the C level. To check derivation at the Perl level, call isa()
as a normal Perl method.
Currently, the only significant value for flags
is SVf_UTF8.
bool sv_derived_from_pvn(SV* sv,
const char *const name,
const STRLEN len, U32 flags)
Exactly like "sv_derived_from_pvn", but takes the name string in the form of an SV instead of a string/length pair.
bool sv_derived_from_sv(SV* sv, SV *namesv,
U32 flags)
Like "sv_does_pv", but doesn't take a flags
parameter.
bool sv_does(SV* sv, const char *const name)
Like "sv_does_sv", but takes a nul-terminated string instead of an SV.
bool sv_does_pv(SV* sv, const char *const name,
U32 flags)
Like "sv_does_sv", but takes a string/length pair instead of an SV.
bool sv_does_pvn(SV* sv, const char *const name,
const STRLEN len, U32 flags)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV performs a specific, named role. The SV can be a Perl object or the name of a Perl class.
bool sv_does_sv(SV* sv, SV* namesv, U32 flags)
Returns a pointer to the spot just after the last character in the string which is in the SV, where there is usually a trailing NUL
character (even though Perl scalars do not strictly require it). See "SvCUR"
. Access the character as *(SvEND(sv))
.
Warning: If SvCUR
is equal to SvLEN
, then SvEND
points to unallocated memory.
char* SvEND(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the strings in the two SVs are identical. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware, handles get magic, and will coerce its args to strings if necessary.
I32 sv_eq(SV* sv1, SV* sv2)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the strings in the two SVs are identical. Is UTF-8 and 'use bytes'
aware and coerces its args to strings if necessary. If the flags has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, it handles get-magic, too.
I32 sv_eq_flags(SV* sv1, SV* sv2, const U32 flags)
Undo various types of fakery on an SV, where fakery means "more than" a string: if the PV is a shared string, make a private copy; if we're a ref, stop refing; if we're a glob, downgrade to an xpvmg; if we're a copy-on-write scalar, this is the on-write time when we do the copy, and is also used locally; if this is a vstring, drop the vstring magic. If SV_COW_DROP_PV
is set then a copy-on-write scalar drops its PV buffer (if any) and becomes SvPOK_off rather than making a copy. (Used where this scalar is about to be set to some other value.) In addition, the flags
parameter gets passed to sv_unref_flags()
when unreffing. sv_force_normal
calls this function with flags set to 0.
This function is expected to be used to signal to perl that this SV is about to be written to, and any extra book-keeping needs to be taken care of. Hence, it croaks on read-only values.
void sv_force_normal_flags(SV *const sv,
const U32 flags)
Decrement an SV's reference count, and if it drops to zero, call sv_clear
to invoke destructors and free up any memory used by the body; finally, deallocating the SV's head itself. Normally called via a wrapper macro SvREFCNT_dec
.
void sv_free(SV *const sv)
Returns true if the SV has get magic or overloading. If either is true then the scalar is active data, and has the potential to return a new value every time it is accessed. Hence you must be careful to only read it once per user logical operation and work with that returned value. If neither is true then the scalar's value cannot change unless written to.
U32 SvGAMAGIC(SV* sv)
Get a line from the filehandle and store it into the SV, optionally appending to the currently-stored string. If append
is not 0, the line is appended to the SV instead of overwriting it. append
should be set to the byte offset that the appended string should start at in the SV (typically, SvCUR(sv)
is a suitable choice).
char* sv_gets(SV *const sv, PerlIO *const fp,
STRLEN append)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
If sv
is the target of a weak reference then it returns the back references structure associated with the sv; otherwise return NULL
.
When returning a non-null result the type of the return is relevant. If it is an AV then the elements of the AV are the weak reference RVs which point at this item. If it is any other type then the item itself is the weak reference.
See also "sv_add_backref" in perlintern, "sv_del_backref" in perlintern, "sv_kill_backrefs" in perlintern
SV* sv_get_backrefs(SV *const sv)
Expands the character buffer in the SV so that it has room for the indicated number of bytes (remember to reserve space for an extra trailing NUL
character). Calls sv_grow
to perform the expansion if necessary. Returns a pointer to the character buffer. SV must be of type >= SVt_PV
. One alternative is to call sv_grow
if you are not sure of the type of SV.
You might mistakenly think that len
is the number of bytes to add to the existing size, but instead it is the total size sv
should be.
char * SvGROW(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Expands the character buffer in the SV. If necessary, uses sv_unref
and upgrades the SV to SVt_PV
. Returns a pointer to the character buffer. Use the SvGROW
wrapper instead.
char* sv_grow(SV *const sv, STRLEN newlen)
Auto-increment of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion if necessary. Handles 'get' magic and operator overloading.
void sv_inc(SV *const sv)
Auto-increment of the value in the SV, doing string to numeric conversion if necessary. Handles operator overloading. Skips handling 'get' magic.
void sv_inc_nomg(SV *const sv)
Inserts and/or replaces a string at the specified offset/length within the SV. Similar to the Perl substr()
function, with littlelen
bytes starting at little
replacing len
bytes of the string in bigstr
starting at offset
. Handles get magic.
void sv_insert(SV *const bigstr, const STRLEN offset,
const STRLEN len,
const char *const little,
const STRLEN littlelen)
Same as sv_insert
, but the extra flags
are passed to the SvPV_force_flags
that applies to bigstr
.
void sv_insert_flags(SV *const bigstr,
const STRLEN offset,
const STRLEN len,
const char *little,
const STRLEN littlelen,
const U32 flags)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains an integer.
U32 SvIOK(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains a signed integer.
bool SvIOK_notUV(SV* sv)
Unsets the IV status of an SV.
void SvIOK_off(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is an integer.
void SvIOK_on(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is an integer and disables all other OK
bits.
void SvIOK_only(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is an unsigned integer and disables all other OK
bits.
void SvIOK_only_UV(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains an integer. Checks the private setting. Use SvIOK
instead.
U32 SvIOKp(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains an integer that must be interpreted as unsigned. A non-negative integer whose value is within the range of both an IV and a UV may be be flagged as either SvUOK
or SVIOK
.
bool SvIOK_UV(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is blessed into the specified class. This does not check for subtypes; use sv_derived_from
to verify an inheritance relationship.
int sv_isa(SV* sv, const char *const name)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV is Copy-On-Write (either shared hash key scalars, or full Copy On Write scalars if 5.9.0 is configured for COW).
U32 SvIsCOW(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is Copy-On-Write shared hash key scalar.
bool SvIsCOW_shared_hash(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV is an RV pointing to a blessed object. If the SV is not an RV, or if the object is not blessed, then this will return false.
int sv_isobject(SV* sv)
Coerces the given SV to IV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's IV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setiv"
to make sure it does).
See "SvIVx"
for a version which guarantees to evaluate sv
only once.
IV SvIV(SV* sv)
Like SvIV
but doesn't process magic.
IV SvIV_nomg(SV* sv)
Set the value of the IV pointer in sv to val. It is possible to perform the same function of this macro with an lvalue assignment to SvIVX
. With future Perls, however, it will be more efficient to use SvIV_set
instead of the lvalue assignment to SvIVX
.
void SvIV_set(SV* sv, IV val)
Returns the raw value in the SV's IV slot, without checks or conversions. Only use when you are sure SvIOK
is true. See also "SvIV"
.
IV SvIVX(SV* sv)
Coerces the given SV to IV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's IV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setiv"
to make sure it does).
This form guarantees to evaluate sv
only once. Only use this if sv
is an expression with side effects, otherwise use the more efficient SvIV
.
IV SvIVx(SV* sv)
Returns the size of the string buffer in the SV, not including any part attributable to SvOOK
. See "SvCUR"
.
STRLEN SvLEN(SV* sv)
Returns the length of the string in the SV. Handles magic and type coercion and sets the UTF8 flag appropriately. See also "SvCUR"
, which gives raw access to the xpv_cur
slot.
STRLEN sv_len(SV *const sv)
Set the size of the string buffer in the SV. See "SvLEN"
and "SvIV_set"
.
void SvLEN_set(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Returns the number of characters in the string in an SV, counting wide UTF-8 bytes as a single character. Handles magic and type coercion.
STRLEN sv_len_utf8(SV *const sv)
Adds magic to an SV. First upgrades sv
to type SVt_PVMG
if necessary, then adds a new magic item of type how
to the head of the magic list.
See "sv_magicext"
(which sv_magic
now calls) for a description of the handling of the name
and namlen
arguments.
You need to use sv_magicext
to add magic to SvREADONLY
SVs and also to add more than one instance of the same how
.
void sv_magic(SV *const sv, SV *const obj,
const int how, const char *const name,
const I32 namlen)
Adds magic to an SV, upgrading it if necessary. Applies the supplied vtable
and returns a pointer to the magic added.
Note that sv_magicext
will allow things that sv_magic
will not. In particular, you can add magic to SvREADONLY
SVs, and add more than one instance of the same how
.
If namlen
is greater than zero then a savepvn
copy of name
is stored, if namlen
is zero then name
is stored as-is and - as another special case - if (name && namlen == HEf_SVKEY)
then name
is assumed to contain an SV* and is stored as-is with its REFCNT
incremented.
(This is now used as a subroutine by sv_magic
.)
MAGIC * sv_magicext(SV *const sv, SV *const obj,
const int how,
const MGVTBL *const vtbl,
const char *const name,
const I32 namlen)
Set the value of the MAGIC pointer in sv
to val. See "SvIV_set"
.
void SvMAGIC_set(SV* sv, MAGIC* val)
Creates a new SV which is a copy of the original SV (using sv_setsv
). The new SV is marked as mortal. It will be destroyed "soon", either by an explicit call to FREETMPS
, or by an implicit call at places such as statement boundaries. See also "sv_newmortal"
and "sv_2mortal"
.
SV* sv_mortalcopy(SV *const oldsv)
Creates a new null SV which is mortal. The reference count of the SV is set to 1. It will be destroyed "soon", either by an explicit call to FREETMPS
, or by an implicit call at places such as statement boundaries. See also "sv_mortalcopy"
and "sv_2mortal"
.
SV* sv_newmortal()
Increment an SV's reference count. Use the SvREFCNT_inc()
wrapper instead.
SV* sv_newref(SV *const sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a number, integer or double.
U32 SvNIOK(SV* sv)
Unsets the NV/IV status of an SV.
void SvNIOK_off(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a number, integer or double. Checks the private setting. Use SvNIOK
instead.
U32 SvNIOKp(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a double.
U32 SvNOK(SV* sv)
Unsets the NV status of an SV.
void SvNOK_off(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is a double.
void SvNOK_on(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is a double and disables all other OK bits.
void SvNOK_only(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a double. Checks the private setting. Use SvNOK
instead.
U32 SvNOKp(SV* sv)
Coerces the given SV to NV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's NV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setnv"
to make sure it does).
See "SvNVx"
for a version which guarantees to evaluate sv
only once.
NV SvNV(SV* sv)
Like SvNV
but doesn't process magic.
NV SvNV_nomg(SV* sv)
Set the value of the NV pointer in sv
to val. See "SvIV_set"
.
void SvNV_set(SV* sv, NV val)
Returns the raw value in the SV's NV slot, without checks or conversions. Only use when you are sure SvNOK
is true. See also "SvNV"
.
NV SvNVX(SV* sv)
Coerces the given SV to NV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's NV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setnv"
to make sure it does).
This form guarantees to evaluate sv
only once. Only use this if sv
is an expression with side effects, otherwise use the more efficient SvNV
.
NV SvNVx(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the value is defined. This is only meaningful for scalars.
U32 SvOK(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 indicating whether the pointer to the string buffer is offset. This hack is used internally to speed up removal of characters from the beginning of a SvPV
. When SvOOK
is true, then the start of the allocated string buffer is actually SvOOK_offset()
bytes before SvPVX
. This offset used to be stored in SvIVX
, but is now stored within the spare part of the buffer.
U32 SvOOK(SV* sv)
Reads into len
the offset from SvPVX
back to the true start of the allocated buffer, which will be non-zero if sv_chop
has been used to efficiently remove characters from start of the buffer. Implemented as a macro, which takes the address of len
, which must be of type STRLEN
. Evaluates sv
more than once. Sets len
to 0 if SvOOK(sv)
is false.
void SvOOK_offset(NN SV*sv, STRLEN len)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a character string.
U32 SvPOK(SV* sv)
Unsets the PV status of an SV.
void SvPOK_off(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is a string.
void SvPOK_on(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is a string and disables all other OK
bits. Will also turn off the UTF-8 status.
void SvPOK_only(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is a string and disables all other OK
bits, and leaves the UTF-8 status as it was.
void SvPOK_only_UTF8(SV* sv)
Returns a U32 value indicating whether the SV contains a character string. Checks the private setting. Use SvPOK
instead.
U32 SvPOKp(SV* sv)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Converts the value pointed to by offsetp
from a count of bytes from the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of UTF-8 chars. Handles magic and type coercion.
Deprecated, use sv_pos_b2u_flags
in preference, which correctly handles strings longer than 2Gb.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void sv_pos_b2u(SV *const sv, I32 *const offsetp)
Converts offset
from a count of bytes from the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of UTF-8 chars. Handles type coercion. flags
is passed to SvPV_flags
, and usually should be SV_GMAGIC|SV_CONST_RETURN
to handle magic.
STRLEN sv_pos_b2u_flags(SV *const sv,
STRLEN const offset, U32 flags)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Converts the value pointed to by offsetp
from a count of UTF-8 chars from the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of bytes; if lenp
is non-zero, it does the same to lenp
, but this time starting from the offset, rather than from the start of the string. Handles magic and type coercion.
Deprecated, use sv_pos_u2b_flags
in preference, which correctly handles strings longer than 2Gb.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void sv_pos_u2b(SV *const sv, I32 *const offsetp,
I32 *const lenp)
Converts the offset from a count of UTF-8 chars from the start of the string, to a count of the equivalent number of bytes; if lenp
is non-zero, it does the same to lenp
, but this time starting from offset
, rather than from the start of the string. Handles type coercion. flags
is passed to SvPV_flags
, and usually should be SV_GMAGIC|SV_CONST_RETURN
to handle magic.
STRLEN sv_pos_u2b_flags(SV *const sv, STRLEN uoffset,
STRLEN *const lenp, U32 flags)
Returns a pointer to the string in the SV, or a stringified form of the SV if the SV does not contain a string. The SV may cache the stringified version becoming SvPOK
. Handles 'get' magic. The len
variable will be set to the length of the string (this is a macro, so don't use &len
). See also "SvPVx"
for a version which guarantees to evaluate sv
only once.
Note that there is no guarantee that the return value of SvPV()
is equal to SvPVX(sv)
, or that SvPVX(sv)
contains valid data, or that successive calls to SvPV(sv)
will return the same pointer value each time. This is due to the way that things like overloading and Copy-On-Write are handled. In these cases, the return value may point to a temporary buffer or similar. If you absolutely need the SvPVX
field to be valid (for example, if you intend to write to it), then see "SvPV_force"
.
char* SvPV(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV
, but converts sv
to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_force
, but converts sv
to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_nolen
, but converts sv
to byte representation first if necessary.
char* SvPVbyte_nolen(SV* sv)
The backend for the SvPVbytex_force
macro. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvbyten_force(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp)
Like SvPV
, but converts sv
to byte representation first if necessary. Guarantees to evaluate sv
only once; use the more efficient SvPVbyte
otherwise.
char* SvPVbytex(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_force
, but converts sv
to byte representation first if necessary. Guarantees to evaluate sv
only once; use the more efficient SvPVbyte_force
otherwise.
char* SvPVbytex_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Ensures that sv is a SVt_PV and that its SvCUR is 0, and that it is properly null terminated. Equivalent to sv_setpvs(""), but more efficient.
char * SvPVCLEAR(SV* sv)
Like SvPV
but will force the SV into containing a string (SvPOK
), and only a string (SvPOK_only
), by hook or by crook. You need force if you are going to update the SvPVX
directly. Processes get magic.
Note that coercing an arbitrary scalar into a plain PV will potentially strip useful data from it. For example if the SV was SvROK
, then the referent will have its reference count decremented, and the SV itself may be converted to an SvPOK
scalar with a string buffer containing a value such as "ARRAY(0x1234)"
.
char* SvPV_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_force
, but doesn't process get magic.
char* SvPV_force_nomg(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV
but doesn't set a length variable.
char* SvPV_nolen(SV* sv)
Like SvPV
but doesn't process magic.
char* SvPV_nomg(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_nolen
but doesn't process magic.
char* SvPV_nomg_nolen(SV* sv)
Get a sensible string out of the SV somehow. A private implementation of the SvPV_force
macro for compilers which can't cope with complex macro expressions. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvn_force(SV* sv, STRLEN* lp)
Get a sensible string out of the SV somehow. If flags
has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, will mg_get
on sv
if appropriate, else not. sv_pvn_force
and sv_pvn_force_nomg
are implemented in terms of this function. You normally want to use the various wrapper macros instead: see "SvPV_force"
and "SvPV_force_nomg"
.
char* sv_pvn_force_flags(SV *const sv,
STRLEN *const lp,
const I32 flags)
This is probably not what you want to use, you probably wanted "sv_usepvn_flags" or "sv_setpvn" or "sv_setpvs".
Set the value of the PV pointer in sv
to the Perl allocated NUL
-terminated string val
. See also "SvIV_set"
.
Remember to free the previous PV buffer. There are many things to check. Beware that the existing pointer may be involved in copy-on-write or other mischief, so do SvOOK_off(sv)
and use sv_force_normal
or SvPV_force
(or check the SvIsCOW
flag) first to make sure this modification is safe. Then finally, if it is not a COW, call SvPV_free
to free the previous PV buffer.
void SvPV_set(SV* sv, char* val)
Like SvPV
, but converts sv
to UTF-8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
The backend for the SvPVutf8x_force
macro. Always use the macro instead.
char* sv_pvutf8n_force(SV *const sv, STRLEN *const lp)
Like SvPV
, but converts sv
to UTF-8 first if necessary. Guarantees to evaluate sv
only once; use the more efficient SvPVutf8
otherwise.
char* SvPVutf8x(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_force
, but converts sv
to UTF-8 first if necessary. Guarantees to evaluate sv
only once; use the more efficient SvPVutf8_force
otherwise.
char* SvPVutf8x_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_force
, but converts sv
to UTF-8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8_force(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Like SvPV_nolen
, but converts sv
to UTF-8 first if necessary.
char* SvPVutf8_nolen(SV* sv)
Returns a pointer to the physical string in the SV. The SV must contain a string. Prior to 5.9.3 it is not safe to execute this macro unless the SV's type >= SVt_PV
.
This is also used to store the name of an autoloaded subroutine in an XS AUTOLOAD routine. See "Autoloading with XSUBs" in perlguts.
char* SvPVX(SV* sv)
A version of SvPV
which guarantees to evaluate sv
only once. Only use this if sv
is an expression with side effects, otherwise use the more efficient SvPV
.
char* SvPVx(SV* sv, STRLEN len)
Returns true if the argument is readonly, otherwise returns false. Exposed to to perl code via Internals::SvREADONLY().
U32 SvREADONLY(SV* sv)
Mark an object as not-readonly. Exactly what this mean depends on the object type. Exposed to perl code via Internals::SvREADONLY().
U32 SvREADONLY_off(SV* sv)
Mark an object as readonly. Exactly what this means depends on the object type. Exposed to perl code via Internals::SvREADONLY().
U32 SvREADONLY_on(SV* sv)
Returns a SV describing what the SV passed in is a reference to.
dst can be a SV to be set to the description or NULL, in which case a mortal SV is returned.
If ob is true and the SV is blessed, the description is the class name, otherwise it is the type of the SV, "SCALAR", "ARRAY" etc.
SV* sv_ref(SV *dst, const SV *const sv,
const int ob)
Returns the value of the object's reference count. Exposed to perl code via Internals::SvREFCNT().
U32 SvREFCNT(SV* sv)
Decrements the reference count of the given SV. sv
may be NULL
.
void SvREFCNT_dec(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_dec
, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL
. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster and smaller.
void SvREFCNT_dec_NN(SV* sv)
Increments the reference count of the given SV, returning the SV.
All of the following SvREFCNT_inc
* macros are optimized versions of SvREFCNT_inc
, and can be replaced with SvREFCNT_inc
.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc
, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL
. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster and smaller.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_NN(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc
, but can only be used with expressions without side effects. Since we don't have to store a temporary value, it's faster.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_simple(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc_simple
, but can only be used if you know sv
is not NULL
. Since we don't have to check the NULLness, it's faster and smaller.
SV* SvREFCNT_inc_simple_NN(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc_simple
, but can only be used if you don't need the return value. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value.
void SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc
, but can only be used if you don't need the return value, and you know that sv
is not NULL
. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value, or check for NULLness, so it's smaller and faster.
void SvREFCNT_inc_simple_void_NN(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc
, but can only be used if you don't need the return value. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value.
void SvREFCNT_inc_void(SV* sv)
Same as SvREFCNT_inc
, but can only be used if you don't need the return value, and you know that sv
is not NULL
. The macro doesn't need to return a meaningful value, or check for NULLness, so it's smaller and faster.
void SvREFCNT_inc_void_NN(SV* sv)
Returns a string describing what the SV is a reference to.
If ob is true and the SV is blessed, the string is the class name, otherwise it is the type of the SV, "SCALAR", "ARRAY" etc.
const char* sv_reftype(const SV *const sv, const int ob)
Make the first argument a copy of the second, then delete the original. The target SV physically takes over ownership of the body of the source SV and inherits its flags; however, the target keeps any magic it owns, and any magic in the source is discarded. Note that this is a rather specialist SV copying operation; most of the time you'll want to use sv_setsv
or one of its many macro front-ends.
void sv_replace(SV *const sv, SV *const nsv)
Dump the contents of all SVs not yet freed (debugging aid).
void sv_report_used()
Underlying implementation for the reset
Perl function. Note that the perl-level function is vaguely deprecated.
void sv_reset(const char* s, HV *const stash)
Tests if the SV is an RV.
U32 SvROK(SV* sv)
Unsets the RV status of an SV.
void SvROK_off(SV* sv)
Tells an SV that it is an RV.
void SvROK_on(SV* sv)
Dereferences an RV to return the SV.
SV* SvRV(SV* sv)
Set the value of the RV pointer in sv
to val. See "SvIV_set"
.
void SvRV_set(SV* sv, SV* val)
Unweaken a reference: Clear the SvWEAKREF
flag on this RV; remove the backreference to this RV from the array of backreferences associated with the target SV, increment the refcount of the target. Silently ignores undef
and warns on non-weak references.
SV* sv_rvunweaken(SV *const sv)
Weaken a reference: set the SvWEAKREF
flag on this RV; give the referred-to SV PERL_MAGIC_backref
magic if it hasn't already; and push a back-reference to this RV onto the array of backreferences associated with that magic. If the RV is magical, set magic will be called after the RV is cleared. Silently ignores undef
and warns on already-weak references.
SV* sv_rvweaken(SV *const sv)
Copies an integer into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary. Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setiv_mg"
.
void sv_setiv(SV *const sv, const IV num)
Like sv_setiv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setiv_mg(SV *const sv, const IV i)
Copies a double into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary. Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setnv_mg"
.
void sv_setnv(SV *const sv, const NV num)
Like sv_setnv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setnv_mg(SV *const sv, const NV num)
Copies a string into an SV. The string must be terminated with a NUL
character, and not contain embeded NUL
's. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpv_mg"
.
void sv_setpv(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
Works like sv_catpvf
but copies the text into the SV instead of appending it. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpvf_mg"
.
void sv_setpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
...)
Like sv_setpvf
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpvf_mg(SV *const sv,
const char *const pat, ...)
Copies an integer into the given SV, also updating its string value. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpviv_mg"
.
void sv_setpviv(SV *const sv, const IV num)
Like sv_setpviv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpviv_mg(SV *const sv, const IV iv)
Copies a string (possibly containing embedded NUL
characters) into an SV. The len
parameter indicates the number of bytes to be copied. If the ptr
argument is NULL the SV will become undefined. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_setpvn_mg"
.
void sv_setpvn(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr,
const STRLEN len)
Like sv_setpvn
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpvn_mg(SV *const sv,
const char *const ptr,
const STRLEN len)
Like sv_setpvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_setpvs(SV* sv, "literal string" s)
Like sv_setpvn_mg
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
void sv_setpvs_mg(SV* sv, "literal string" s)
Sets the SV to be a string of cur bytes length, with at least len bytes available. Ensures that there is a null byte at SvEND. Returns a char * pointer to the SvPV buffer.
char * sv_setpv_bufsize(SV *const sv, const STRLEN cur,
const STRLEN len)
Like sv_setpv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setpv_mg(SV *const sv, const char *const ptr)
Copies an integer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The rv
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. The classname
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set classname
to NULL
to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_iv(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname,
const IV iv)
Copies a double into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The rv
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. The classname
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set classname
to NULL
to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_nv(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname,
const NV nv)
Copies a pointer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The rv
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. If the pv
argument is NULL
, then PL_sv_undef
will be placed into the SV. The classname
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set classname
to NULL
to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
Do not use with other Perl types such as HV, AV, SV, CV, because those objects will become corrupted by the pointer copy process.
Note that sv_setref_pvn
copies the string while this copies the pointer.
SV* sv_setref_pv(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname,
void *const pv)
Copies a string into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The length of the string must be specified with n
. The rv
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. The classname
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set classname
to NULL
to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
Note that sv_setref_pv
copies the pointer while this copies the string.
SV* sv_setref_pvn(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname,
const char *const pv,
const STRLEN n)
Like sv_setref_pvn
, but takes a literal string instead of a string/length pair.
SV * sv_setref_pvs("literal string" s)
Copies an unsigned integer into a new SV, optionally blessing the SV. The rv
argument will be upgraded to an RV. That RV will be modified to point to the new SV. The classname
argument indicates the package for the blessing. Set classname
to NULL
to avoid the blessing. The new SV will have a reference count of 1, and the RV will be returned.
SV* sv_setref_uv(SV *const rv,
const char *const classname,
const UV uv)
Copies the contents of the source SV ssv
into the destination SV dsv
. The source SV may be destroyed if it is mortal, so don't use this function if the source SV needs to be reused. Does not handle 'set' magic on destination SV. Calls 'get' magic on source SV. Loosely speaking, it performs a copy-by-value, obliterating any previous content of the destination.
You probably want to use one of the assortment of wrappers, such as SvSetSV
, SvSetSV_nosteal
, SvSetMagicSV
and SvSetMagicSV_nosteal
.
void sv_setsv(SV *dstr, SV *sstr)
Copies the contents of the source SV ssv
into the destination SV dsv
. The source SV may be destroyed if it is mortal, so don't use this function if the source SV needs to be reused. Does not handle 'set' magic. Loosely speaking, it performs a copy-by-value, obliterating any previous content of the destination. If the flags
parameter has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, will mg_get
on ssv
if appropriate, else not. If the flags
parameter has the SV_NOSTEAL
bit set then the buffers of temps will not be stolen. sv_setsv
and sv_setsv_nomg
are implemented in terms of this function.
You probably want to use one of the assortment of wrappers, such as SvSetSV
, SvSetSV_nosteal
, SvSetMagicSV
and SvSetMagicSV_nosteal
.
This is the primary function for copying scalars, and most other copy-ish functions and macros use this underneath.
void sv_setsv_flags(SV *dstr, SV *sstr,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_setsv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setsv_mg(SV *const dstr, SV *const sstr)
Like sv_setsv
but doesn't process magic.
void sv_setsv_nomg(SV* dsv, SV* ssv)
Copies an unsigned integer into the given SV, upgrading first if necessary. Does not handle 'set' magic. See also "sv_setuv_mg"
.
void sv_setuv(SV *const sv, const UV num)
Like sv_setuv
, but also handles 'set' magic.
void sv_setuv_mg(SV *const sv, const UV u)
Equivalent to sv_setsv(sv, UNDEF)
, but more efficient. Doesn't handle set magic.
The perl equivalent is $sv = undef;
. Note that it doesn't free any string buffer, unlike undef $sv
.
Introduced in perl 5.27.3.
void sv_set_undef(SV *sv)
Returns the stash of the SV.
HV* SvSTASH(SV* sv)
Set the value of the STASH pointer in sv
to val. See "SvIV_set"
.
void SvSTASH_set(SV* sv, HV* val)
Taints an SV if tainting is enabled, and if some input to the current expression is tainted--usually a variable, but possibly also implicit inputs such as locale settings. SvTAINT
propagates that taintedness to the outputs of an expression in a pessimistic fashion; i.e., without paying attention to precisely which outputs are influenced by which inputs.
void SvTAINT(SV* sv)
Checks to see if an SV is tainted. Returns TRUE if it is, FALSE if not.
bool SvTAINTED(SV* sv)
Test an SV for taintedness. Use SvTAINTED
instead.
bool sv_tainted(SV *const sv)
Untaints an SV. Be very careful with this routine, as it short-circuits some of Perl's fundamental security features. XS module authors should not use this function unless they fully understand all the implications of unconditionally untainting the value. Untainting should be done in the standard perl fashion, via a carefully crafted regexp, rather than directly untainting variables.
void SvTAINTED_off(SV* sv)
Marks an SV as tainted if tainting is enabled.
void SvTAINTED_on(SV* sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether Perl would evaluate the SV as true or false. See "SvOK"
for a defined/undefined test. Handles 'get' magic unless the scalar is already SvPOK
, SvIOK
or SvNOK
(the public, not the private flags).
bool SvTRUE(SV* sv)
Returns true if the SV has a true value by Perl's rules. Use the SvTRUE
macro instead, which may call sv_true()
or may instead use an in-line version.
I32 sv_true(SV *const sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether Perl would evaluate the SV as true or false. See "SvOK"
for a defined/undefined test. Does not handle 'get' magic.
bool SvTRUE_nomg(SV* sv)
Returns the type of the SV. See "svtype"
.
svtype SvTYPE(SV* sv)
If you change any flag of a COW string, you need to uncow it to ensure that all other references to this string are not affected by this change also. This is less expensive and special as sv_force_normal_flags
.
void sv_uncow(SV *const sv, const U32 flags)
Removes all magic of type type
from an SV.
int sv_unmagic(SV *const sv, const int type)
Removes all magic of type type
with the specified vtbl
from an SV.
int sv_unmagicext(SV *const sv, const int type,
MGVTBL *vtbl)
Unsets the RV status of the SV, and decrements the reference count of whatever was being referenced by the RV. This can almost be thought of as a reversal of newSVrv
. The cflags
argument can contain SV_IMMEDIATE_UNREF
to force the reference count to be decremented (otherwise the decrementing is conditional on the reference count being different from one or the reference being a readonly SV). See "SvROK_off"
.
void sv_unref_flags(SV *const ref, const U32 flags)
Untaint an SV. Use SvTAINTED_off
instead.
void sv_untaint(SV *const sv)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains an integer that must be interpreted as unsigned. A non-negative integer whose value is within the range of both an IV and a UV may be be flagged as either SvUOK
or SVIOK
.
bool SvUOK(SV* sv)
Used to upgrade an SV to a more complex form. Uses sv_upgrade
to perform the upgrade if necessary. See "svtype"
.
void SvUPGRADE(SV* sv, svtype type)
Upgrade an SV to a more complex form. Generally adds a new body type to the SV, then copies across as much information as possible from the old body. It croaks if the SV is already in a more complex form than requested. You generally want to use the SvUPGRADE
macro wrapper, which checks the type before calling sv_upgrade
, and hence does not croak. See also "svtype"
.
void sv_upgrade(SV *const sv, svtype new_type)
Tells an SV to use ptr
to find its string value. Normally the string is stored inside the SV, but sv_usepvn allows the SV to use an outside string. ptr
should point to memory that was allocated by Newx
. It must be the start of a Newx
-ed block of memory, and not a pointer to the middle of it (beware of OOK
and copy-on-write), and not be from a non-Newx
memory allocator like malloc
. The string length, len
, must be supplied. By default this function will Renew
(i.e. realloc, move) the memory pointed to by ptr
, so that pointer should not be freed or used by the programmer after giving it to sv_usepvn
, and neither should any pointers from "behind" that pointer (e.g. ptr + 1) be used.
If flags & SV_SMAGIC
is true, will call SvSETMAGIC
. If flags & SV_HAS_TRAILING_NUL
is true, then ptr[len]
must be NUL
, and the realloc will be skipped (i.e. the buffer is actually at least 1 byte longer than len
, and already meets the requirements for storing in SvPVX
).
void sv_usepvn_flags(SV *const sv, char* ptr,
const STRLEN len,
const U32 flags)
Returns a U32 value indicating the UTF-8 status of an SV. If things are set-up properly, this indicates whether or not the SV contains UTF-8 encoded data. You should use this after a call to SvPV()
or one of its variants, in case any call to string overloading updates the internal flag.
If you want to take into account the bytes pragma, use "DO_UTF8"
instead.
U32 SvUTF8(SV* sv)
If the PV of the SV is an octet sequence in Perl's extended UTF-8 and contains a multiple-byte character, the SvUTF8
flag is turned on so that it looks like a character. If the PV contains only single-byte characters, the SvUTF8
flag stays off. Scans PV for validity and returns FALSE if the PV is invalid UTF-8.
bool sv_utf8_decode(SV *const sv)
Attempts to convert the PV of an SV from characters to bytes. If the PV contains a character that cannot fit in a byte, this conversion will fail; in this case, either returns false or, if fail_ok
is not true, croaks.
This is not a general purpose Unicode to byte encoding interface: use the Encode
extension for that.
bool sv_utf8_downgrade(SV *const sv,
const bool fail_ok)
Converts the PV of an SV to UTF-8, but then turns the SvUTF8
flag off so that it looks like octets again.
void sv_utf8_encode(SV *const sv)
Converts the PV of an SV to its UTF-8-encoded form. Forces the SV to string form if it is not already. Will mg_get
on sv
if appropriate. Always sets the SvUTF8
flag to avoid future validity checks even if the whole string is the same in UTF-8 as not. Returns the number of bytes in the converted string
This is not a general purpose byte encoding to Unicode interface: use the Encode extension for that.
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade(SV *sv)
Converts the PV of an SV to its UTF-8-encoded form. Forces the SV to string form if it is not already. Always sets the SvUTF8 flag to avoid future validity checks even if all the bytes are invariant in UTF-8. If flags
has SV_GMAGIC
bit set, will mg_get
on sv
if appropriate, else not.
The SV_FORCE_UTF8_UPGRADE
flag is now ignored.
Returns the number of bytes in the converted string.
This is not a general purpose byte encoding to Unicode interface: use the Encode extension for that.
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_flags(SV *const sv,
const I32 flags)
Like sv_utf8_upgrade_flags
, but has an additional parameter extra
, which is the number of unused bytes the string of sv
is guaranteed to have free after it upon return. This allows the caller to reserve extra space that it intends to fill, to avoid extra grows.
sv_utf8_upgrade
, sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg
, and sv_utf8_upgrade_flags
are implemented in terms of this function.
Returns the number of bytes in the converted string (not including the spares).
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_flags_grow(SV *const sv,
const I32 flags,
STRLEN extra)
Like sv_utf8_upgrade
, but doesn't do magic on sv
.
STRLEN sv_utf8_upgrade_nomg(SV *sv)
Unsets the UTF-8 status of an SV (the data is not changed, just the flag). Do not use frivolously.
void SvUTF8_off(SV *sv)
Turn on the UTF-8 status of an SV (the data is not changed, just the flag). Do not use frivolously.
void SvUTF8_on(SV *sv)
Coerces the given SV to UV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's UV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setuv"
to make sure it does).
See "SvUVx"
for a version which guarantees to evaluate sv
only once.
UV SvUV(SV* sv)
Like SvUV
but doesn't process magic.
UV SvUV_nomg(SV* sv)
Set the value of the UV pointer in sv
to val. See "SvIV_set"
.
void SvUV_set(SV* sv, UV val)
Returns the raw value in the SV's UV slot, without checks or conversions. Only use when you are sure SvIOK
is true. See also "SvUV"
.
UV SvUVX(SV* sv)
Coerces the given SV to UV and returns it. The returned value in many circumstances will get stored in sv
's UV slot, but not in all cases. (Use "sv_setuv"
to make sure it does).
This form guarantees to evaluate sv
only once. Only use this if sv
is an expression with side effects, otherwise use the more efficient SvUV
.
UV SvUVx(SV* sv)
Processes its arguments like sv_vcatpvfn
called with a non-null C-style variable argument list, and appends the formatted output to an SV. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_vcatpvf_mg"
.
Usually used via its frontend sv_catpvf
.
void sv_vcatpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
va_list *const args)
void sv_vcatpvfn(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
const STRLEN patlen,
va_list *const args,
SV **const svargs,
const int sv_count,
bool *const maybe_tainted)
Processes its arguments like vsprintf
and appends the formatted output to an SV. Uses an array of SVs if the C-style variable argument list is missing (NULL
). Argument reordering (using format specifiers like %2$d
or %*2$d
) is supported only when using an array of SVs; using a C-style va_list
argument list with a format string that uses argument reordering will yield an exception.
When running with taint checks enabled, indicates via maybe_tainted
if results are untrustworthy (often due to the use of locales).
If called as sv_vcatpvfn
or flags has the SV_GMAGIC
bit set, calls get magic.
It assumes that pat has the same utf8-ness as sv. It's the caller's responsibility to ensure that this is so.
Usually used via one of its frontends sv_vcatpvf
and sv_vcatpvf_mg
.
void sv_vcatpvfn_flags(SV *const sv,
const char *const pat,
const STRLEN patlen,
va_list *const args,
SV **const svargs,
const int sv_count,
bool *const maybe_tainted,
const U32 flags)
Like sv_vcatpvf
, but also handles 'set' magic.
Usually used via its frontend sv_catpvf_mg
.
void sv_vcatpvf_mg(SV *const sv,
const char *const pat,
va_list *const args)
Returns a boolean indicating whether the SV contains a v-string.
bool SvVOK(SV* sv)
Works like sv_vcatpvf
but copies the text into the SV instead of appending it. Does not handle 'set' magic. See "sv_vsetpvf_mg"
.
Usually used via its frontend sv_setpvf
.
void sv_vsetpvf(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
va_list *const args)
Works like sv_vcatpvfn
but copies the text into the SV instead of appending it.
Usually used via one of its frontends sv_vsetpvf
and sv_vsetpvf_mg
.
void sv_vsetpvfn(SV *const sv, const char *const pat,
const STRLEN patlen,
va_list *const args,
SV **const svargs,
const int sv_count,
bool *const maybe_tainted)
Like sv_vsetpvf
, but also handles 'set' magic.
Usually used via its frontend sv_setpvf_mg
.
void sv_vsetpvf_mg(SV *const sv,
const char *const pat,
va_list *const args)
"Unicode Support" in perlguts has an introduction to this API.
See also "Character classification", and "Character case changing". Various functions outside this section also work specially with Unicode. Search for the string "utf8" in this document.
This is a macro that evaluates to a string constant of the UTF-8 bytes that define the Unicode BYTE ORDER MARK (U+FEFF) for the platform that perl is compiled on. This allows code to use a mnemonic for this character that works on both ASCII and EBCDIC platforms. sizeof(BOM_UTF8) - 1
can be used to get its length in bytes.
Compares the sequence of characters (stored as octets) in b
, blen
with the sequence of characters (stored as UTF-8) in u
, ulen
. Returns 0 if they are equal, -1 or -2 if the first string is less than the second string, +1 or +2 if the first string is greater than the second string.
-1 or +1 is returned if the shorter string was identical to the start of the longer string. -2 or +2 is returned if there was a difference between characters within the strings.
int bytes_cmp_utf8(const U8 *b, STRLEN blen,
const U8 *u, STRLEN ulen)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Converts a potentially UTF-8 encoded string s
of length *lenp
into native byte encoding. On input, the boolean *is_utf8p
gives whether or not s
is actually encoded in UTF-8.
Unlike "utf8_to_bytes" but like "bytes_to_utf8", this is non-destructive of the input string.
Do nothing if *is_utf8p
is 0, or if there are code points in the string not expressible in native byte encoding. In these cases, *is_utf8p
and *lenp
are unchanged, and the return value is the original s
.
Otherwise, *is_utf8p
is set to 0, and the return value is a pointer to a newly created string containing a downgraded copy of s
, and whose length is returned in *lenp
, updated. The new string is NUL
-terminated. The caller is responsible for arranging for the memory used by this string to get freed.
Upon successful return, the number of variants in the string can be computed by having saved the value of *lenp
before the call, and subtracting the after-call value of *lenp
from it.
U8* bytes_from_utf8(const U8 *s, STRLEN *lenp,
bool *is_utf8p)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Converts a string s
of length *lenp
bytes from the native encoding into UTF-8. Returns a pointer to the newly-created string, and sets *lenp
to reflect the new length in bytes. The caller is responsible for arranging for the memory used by this string to get freed.
Upon successful return, the number of variants in the string can be computed by having saved the value of *lenp
before the call, and subtracting it from the after-call value of *lenp
.
A NUL
character will be written after the end of the string.
If you want to convert to UTF-8 from encodings other than the native (Latin1 or EBCDIC), see "sv_recode_to_utf8"().
U8* bytes_to_utf8(const U8 *s, STRLEN *lenp)
Returns a bool giving whether or not the PV in sv
is to be treated as being encoded in UTF-8.
You should use this after a call to SvPV()
or one of its variants, in case any call to string overloading updates the internal UTF-8 encoding flag.
bool DO_UTF8(SV* sv)
Returns true if the leading portions of the strings s1
and s2
(either or both of which may be in UTF-8) are the same case-insensitively; false otherwise. How far into the strings to compare is determined by other input parameters.
If u1
is true, the string s1
is assumed to be in UTF-8-encoded Unicode; otherwise it is assumed to be in native 8-bit encoding. Correspondingly for u2
with respect to s2
.
If the byte length l1
is non-zero, it says how far into s1
to check for fold equality. In other words, s1
+l1
will be used as a goal to reach. The scan will not be considered to be a match unless the goal is reached, and scanning won't continue past that goal. Correspondingly for l2
with respect to s2
.
If pe1
is non-NULL
and the pointer it points to is not NULL
, that pointer is considered an end pointer to the position 1 byte past the maximum point in s1
beyond which scanning will not continue under any circumstances. (This routine assumes that UTF-8 encoded input strings are not malformed; malformed input can cause it to read past pe1
). This means that if both l1
and pe1
are specified, and pe1
is less than s1
+l1
, the match will never be successful because it can never get as far as its goal (and in fact is asserted against). Correspondingly for pe2
with respect to s2
.
At least one of s1
and s2
must have a goal (at least one of l1
and l2
must be non-zero), and if both do, both have to be reached for a successful match. Also, if the fold of a character is multiple characters, all of them must be matched (see tr21 reference below for 'folding').
Upon a successful match, if pe1
is non-NULL
, it will be set to point to the beginning of the next character of s1
beyond what was matched. Correspondingly for pe2
and s2
.
For case-insensitiveness, the "casefolding" of Unicode is used instead of upper/lowercasing both the characters, see http://www.unicode.org/unicode/reports/tr21/ (Case Mappings).
I32 foldEQ_utf8(const char *s1, char **pe1, UV l1,
bool u1, const char *s2, char **pe2,
UV l2, bool u2)
This is a misleadingly-named synonym for "is_utf8_invariant_string". On ASCII-ish platforms, the name isn't misleading: the ASCII-range characters are exactly the UTF-8 invariants. But EBCDIC machines have more invariants than just the ASCII characters, so is_utf8_invariant_string
is preferred.
bool is_ascii_string(const U8* const s, STRLEN len)
Returns TRUE if the first len
bytes of string s
form a valid UTF-8-encoded string that conforms to Unicode Corrigendum #9; otherwise it returns FALSE. If len
is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s)
(which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte). Note that all characters being ASCII constitute 'a valid UTF-8 string'.
This function returns FALSE for strings containing any code points above the Unicode max of 0x10FFFF or surrogate code points, but accepts non-character code points per Corrigendum #9.
See also "is_utf8_invariant_string"
, "is_utf8_invariant_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string"
, "is_utf8_string_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
, "is_strict_utf8_string"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_c9strict_utf8_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
Like "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer.
See also "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep)
Like "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer, and the number of UTF-8 encoded characters in the el
pointer.
See also "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
.
bool is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep,
STRLEN *el)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8 that represents some Unicode non-surrogate code point; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation. Any bytes remaining before e
, but beyond the ones needed to form the first code point in s
, are not examined.
The largest acceptable code point is the Unicode maximum 0x10FFFF. This differs from "isSTRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
only in that it accepts non-character code points. This corresponds to Unicode Corrigendum #9. which said that non-character code points are merely discouraged rather than completely forbidden in open interchange. See "Noncharacter code points" in perlunicode.
Use "isUTF8_CHAR"
to check for Perl's extended UTF-8; and "isUTF8_CHAR_flags"
for a more customized definition.
Use "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
to check entire strings.
STRLEN isC9_STRICT_UTF8_CHAR(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
This is a somewhat misleadingly-named synonym for "is_utf8_invariant_string". is_utf8_invariant_string
is preferred, as it indicates under what conditions the string is invariant.
bool is_invariant_string(const U8* const s,
STRLEN len)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8 that represents some Unicode code point completely acceptable for open interchange between all applications; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation. Any bytes remaining before e
, but beyond the ones needed to form the first code point in s
, are not examined.
The largest acceptable code point is the Unicode maximum 0x10FFFF, and must not be a surrogate nor a non-character code point. Thus this excludes any code point from Perl's extended UTF-8.
This is used to efficiently decide if the next few bytes in s
is legal Unicode-acceptable UTF-8 for a single character.
Use "isC9_STRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
to use the Unicode Corrigendum #9 definition of allowable code points; "isUTF8_CHAR"
to check for Perl's extended UTF-8; and "isUTF8_CHAR_flags"
for a more customized definition.
Use "is_strict_utf8_string"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
to check entire strings.
Size_t isSTRICT_UTF8_CHAR(const U8 * const s0,
const U8 * const e)
Returns TRUE if the first len
bytes of string s
form a valid UTF-8-encoded string that is fully interchangeable by any application using Unicode rules; otherwise it returns FALSE. If len
is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s)
(which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte). Note that all characters being ASCII constitute 'a valid UTF-8 string'.
This function returns FALSE for strings containing any code points above the Unicode max of 0x10FFFF, surrogate code points, or non-character code points.
See also "is_utf8_invariant_string"
, "is_utf8_invariant_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string"
, "is_utf8_string_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_strict_utf8_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
Like "is_strict_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer.
See also "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_strict_utf8_string_loc(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep)
Like "is_strict_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer, and the number of UTF-8 encoded characters in the el
pointer.
See also "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
.
bool is_strict_utf8_string_loclen(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep,
STRLEN *el)
Returns TRUE if the fixed-width buffer starting at s
with length len
is entirely valid UTF-8, subject to the restrictions given by flags
; otherwise it returns FALSE.
If flags
is 0, any well-formed UTF-8, as extended by Perl, is accepted without restriction. If the final few bytes of the buffer do not form a complete code point, this will return TRUE anyway, provided that "is_utf8_valid_partial_char_flags"
returns TRUE for them.
If flags
in non-zero, it can be any combination of the UTF8_DISALLOW_foo
flags accepted by "utf8n_to_uvchr"
, and with the same meanings.
This function differs from "is_utf8_string_flags"
only in that the latter returns FALSE if the final few bytes of the string don't form a complete code point.
bool is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags(
const U8 * const s, STRLEN len,
const U32 flags
)
Like "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
but stores the number of complete, valid characters found in the el
pointer.
bool is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags(
const U8 * const s, STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep, STRLEN *el, const U32 flags
)
Like "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
but stores the location of the failure in the ep
pointer. If the function returns TRUE, *ep
will point to the beginning of any partial character at the end of the buffer; if there is no partial character *ep
will contain s
+len
.
See also "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
.
bool is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags(
const U8 * const s, STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep, const U32 flags
)
Returns TRUE if the first len
bytes of the string s
are the same regardless of the UTF-8 encoding of the string (or UTF-EBCDIC encoding on EBCDIC machines); otherwise it returns FALSE. That is, it returns TRUE if they are UTF-8 invariant. On ASCII-ish machines, all the ASCII characters and only the ASCII characters fit this definition. On EBCDIC machines, the ASCII-range characters are invariant, but so also are the C1 controls.
If len
is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s)
, (which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte).
See also "is_utf8_string"
, "is_utf8_string_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
, "is_strict_utf8_string"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_utf8_invariant_string(const U8* const s,
STRLEN len)
Like "is_utf8_invariant_string"
but upon failure, stores the location of the first UTF-8 variant character in the ep
pointer; if all characters are UTF-8 invariant, this function does not change the contents of *ep
.
bool is_utf8_invariant_string_loc(const U8* const s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 ** ep)
Returns TRUE if the first len
bytes of string s
form a valid Perl-extended-UTF-8 string; returns FALSE otherwise. If len
is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s)
(which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte). Note that all characters being ASCII constitute 'a valid UTF-8 string'.
This function considers Perl's extended UTF-8 to be valid. That means that code points above Unicode, surrogates, and non-character code points are considered valid by this function. Use "is_strict_utf8_string"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
, or "is_utf8_string_flags"
to restrict what code points are considered valid.
See also "is_utf8_invariant_string"
, "is_utf8_invariant_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
,
bool is_utf8_string(const U8 *s, STRLEN len)
Returns TRUE if the first len
bytes of string s
form a valid UTF-8 string, subject to the restrictions imposed by flags
; returns FALSE otherwise. If len
is 0, it will be calculated using strlen(s)
(which means if you use this option, that s
can't have embedded NUL
characters and has to have a terminating NUL
byte). Note that all characters being ASCII constitute 'a valid UTF-8 string'.
If flags
is 0, this gives the same results as "is_utf8_string"
; if flags
is UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
, this gives the same results as "is_strict_utf8_string"
; and if flags
is UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
, this gives the same results as "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
. Otherwise flags
may be any combination of the UTF8_DISALLOW_foo
flags understood by "utf8n_to_uvchr"
, with the same meanings.
See also "is_utf8_invariant_string"
, "is_utf8_invariant_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_utf8_string_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loc_flags"
, "is_utf8_fixed_width_buf_loclen_flags"
, "is_strict_utf8_string"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loc"
, "is_strict_utf8_string_loclen"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string"
, "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_c9strict_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_utf8_string_flags(const U8 *s, STRLEN len,
const U32 flags)
Like "is_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer.
See also "is_utf8_string_loclen"
.
bool is_utf8_string_loc(const U8 *s,
const STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep)
Like "is_utf8_string"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer, and the number of UTF-8 encoded characters in the el
pointer.
See also "is_utf8_string_loc"
.
bool is_utf8_string_loclen(const U8 *s, STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep, STRLEN *el)
Like "is_utf8_string_flags"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer, and the number of UTF-8 encoded characters in the el
pointer.
See also "is_utf8_string_loc_flags"
.
bool is_utf8_string_loclen_flags(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep,
STRLEN *el,
const U32 flags)
Like "is_utf8_string_flags"
but stores the location of the failure (in the case of "utf8ness failure") or the location s
+len
(in the case of "utf8ness success") in the ep
pointer.
See also "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags"
.
bool is_utf8_string_loc_flags(const U8 *s,
STRLEN len,
const U8 **ep,
const U32 flags)
Returns 0 if the sequence of bytes starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
is the UTF-8 encoding, as extended by Perl, for one or more code points. Otherwise, it returns 1 if there exists at least one non-empty sequence of bytes that when appended to sequence s
, starting at position e
causes the entire sequence to be the well-formed UTF-8 of some code point; otherwise returns 0.
In other words this returns TRUE if s
points to a partial UTF-8-encoded code point.
This is useful when a fixed-length buffer is being tested for being well-formed UTF-8, but the final few bytes in it don't comprise a full character; that is, it is split somewhere in the middle of the final code point's UTF-8 representation. (Presumably when the buffer is refreshed with the next chunk of data, the new first bytes will complete the partial code point.) This function is used to verify that the final bytes in the current buffer are in fact the legal beginning of some code point, so that if they aren't, the failure can be signalled without having to wait for the next read.
bool is_utf8_valid_partial_char(const U8 * const s,
const U8 * const e)
Like "is_utf8_valid_partial_char"
, it returns a boolean giving whether or not the input is a valid UTF-8 encoded partial character, but it takes an extra parameter, flags
, which can further restrict which code points are considered valid.
If flags
is 0, this behaves identically to "is_utf8_valid_partial_char"
. Otherwise flags
can be any combination of the UTF8_DISALLOW_foo
flags accepted by "utf8n_to_uvchr"
. If there is any sequence of bytes that can complete the input partial character in such a way that a non-prohibited character is formed, the function returns TRUE; otherwise FALSE. Non character code points cannot be determined based on partial character input. But many of the other possible excluded types can be determined from just the first one or two bytes.
bool is_utf8_valid_partial_char_flags(
const U8 * const s, const U8 * const e,
const U32 flags
)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8, as extended by Perl, that represents some code point; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation. Any bytes remaining before e
, but beyond the ones needed to form the first code point in s
, are not examined.
The code point can be any that will fit in an IV on this machine, using Perl's extension to official UTF-8 to represent those higher than the Unicode maximum of 0x10FFFF. That means that this macro is used to efficiently decide if the next few bytes in s
is legal UTF-8 for a single character.
Use "isSTRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
to restrict the acceptable code points to those defined by Unicode to be fully interchangeable across applications; "isC9_STRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
to use the Unicode Corrigendum #9 definition of allowable code points; and "isUTF8_CHAR_flags"
for a more customized definition.
Use "is_utf8_string"
, "is_utf8_string_loc"
, and "is_utf8_string_loclen"
to check entire strings.
Note also that a UTF-8 "invariant" character (i.e. ASCII on non-EBCDIC machines) is a valid UTF-8 character.
STRLEN isUTF8_CHAR(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8, as extended by Perl, that represents some code point, subject to the restrictions given by flags
; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation. Any bytes remaining before e
, but beyond the ones needed to form the first code point in s
, are not examined.
If flags
is 0, this gives the same results as "isUTF8_CHAR"
; if flags
is UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
, this gives the same results as "isSTRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
; and if flags
is UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
, this gives the same results as "isC9_STRICT_UTF8_CHAR"
. Otherwise flags
may be any combination of the UTF8_DISALLOW_foo
flags understood by "utf8n_to_uvchr"
, with the same meanings.
The three alternative macros are for the most commonly needed validations; they are likely to run somewhat faster than this more general one, as they can be inlined into your code.
Use "is_utf8_string_flags", "is_utf8_string_loc_flags", and "is_utf8_string_loclen_flags" to check entire strings.
STRLEN isUTF8_CHAR_flags(const U8 *s, const U8 *e,
const U32 flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Check for the right-hand-side of the Decomposition_Mapping property, which means the codepoint can be normalized, if the sequence is decomposed (NFD or NFKD).
This is equivalent to all 1963 \p{IsM}
Mark characters, plus the remaining 869 non-mark and non-hangul normalizables.
bool _is_decomposed_string(const U8 *p, STRLEN len)
Build to the scalar dsv
a displayable version of the string spv
, length len
, the displayable version being at most pvlim
bytes long (if longer, the rest is truncated and "..."
will be appended).
The flags
argument can have UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT
set to display isPRINT()
able characters as themselves, UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH
to display the \\[nrfta\\]
as the backslashed versions (like "\n"
) (UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH
is preferred over UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT
for "\\"
). UNI_DISPLAY_QQ
(and its alias UNI_DISPLAY_REGEX
) have both UNI_DISPLAY_BACKSLASH
and UNI_DISPLAY_ISPRINT
turned on.
The pointer to the PV of the dsv
is returned.
See also "sv_uni_display".
char* pv_uni_display(SV *dsv, const U8 *spv,
STRLEN len, STRLEN pvlim,
UV flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Normalize the UTF-8 string to NFC, for all symbols and identifiers. Returns a fresh copy of the PV.
The maximal source length is 1024.
char* pv_uni_normalize(char *s1, STRLEN len,
STRLEN *dlenp)
This is a macro that evaluates to a string constant of the UTF-8 bytes that define the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER (U+FFFD) for the platform that perl is compiled on. This allows code to use a mnemonic for this character that works on both ASCII and EBCDIC platforms. sizeof(REPLACEMENT_CHARACTER_UTF8) - 1
can be used to get its length in bytes.
encoding
is assumed to be an Encode
object, the PV of ssv
is assumed to be octets in that encoding and decoding the input starts from the position which (PV + *offset)
pointed to. dsv
will be concatenated with the decoded UTF-8 string from ssv
. Decoding will terminate when the string tstr
appears in decoding output or the input ends on the PV of ssv
. The value which offset
points will be modified to the last input position on ssv
.
Returns TRUE if the terminator was found, else returns FALSE.
bool sv_cat_decode(SV* dsv, SV *encoding, SV *ssv,
int *offset, char* tstr, int tlen)
encoding
is assumed to be an Encode
object, on entry the PV of sv
is assumed to be octets in that encoding, and sv
will be converted into Unicode (and UTF-8).
If sv
already is UTF-8 (or if it is not POK
), or if encoding
is not a reference, nothing is done to sv
. If encoding
is not an Encode::XS
Encoding object, bad things will happen. (See cpan/Encode/encoding.pm and Encode.)
The PV of sv
is returned.
char* sv_recode_to_utf8(SV* sv, SV *encoding)
Build to the scalar dsv
a displayable version of the scalar sv
, the displayable version being at most pvlim
bytes long (if longer, the rest is truncated and "..." will be appended).
The flags
argument is as in "pv_uni_display"().
The pointer to the PV of the dsv
is returned.
char* sv_uni_display(SV *dsv, SV *ssv, STRLEN pvlim,
UV flags)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Instead use "toFOLD_utf8_safe".
UV to_utf8_fold(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp,
STRLEN *lenp)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Instead use "toLOWER_utf8_safe".
UV to_utf8_lower(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp,
STRLEN *lenp)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Instead use "toTITLE_utf8_safe".
UV to_utf8_title(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp,
STRLEN *lenp)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Instead use "toUPPER_utf8_safe".
UV to_utf8_upper(const U8 *p, U8* ustrp,
STRLEN *lenp)
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES. Most code should use "utf8_to_uvchr_buf"() rather than call this directly.
Bottom level UTF-8 decode routine. Returns the native code point value of the first character in the string s
, which is assumed to be in UTF-8 (or UTF-EBCDIC) encoding, and no longer than curlen
bytes; *retlen
(if retlen
isn't NULL) will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
The value of flags
determines the behavior when s
does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character. If flags
is 0, encountering a malformation causes zero to be returned and *retlen
is set so that (s
+ *retlen
) is the next possible position in s
that could begin a non-malformed character. Also, if UTF-8 warnings haven't been lexically disabled, a warning is raised. Some UTF-8 input sequences may contain multiple malformations. This function tries to find every possible one in each call, so multiple warnings can be raised for the same sequence.
Various ALLOW flags can be set in flags
to allow (and not warn on) individual types of malformations, such as the sequence being overlong (that is, when there is a shorter sequence that can express the same code point; overlong sequences are expressly forbidden in the UTF-8 standard due to potential security issues). Another malformation example is the first byte of a character not being a legal first byte. See utf8.h for the list of such flags. Even if allowed, this function generally returns the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER when it encounters a malformation. There are flags in utf8.h to override this behavior for the overlong malformations, but don't do that except for very specialized purposes.
The UTF8_CHECK_ONLY
flag overrides the behavior when a non-allowed (by other flags) malformation is found. If this flag is set, the routine assumes that the caller will raise a warning, and this function will silently just set retlen
to -1
(cast to STRLEN
) and return zero.
Note that this API requires disambiguation between successful decoding a NUL
character, and an error return (unless the UTF8_CHECK_ONLY
flag is set), as in both cases, 0 is returned, and, depending on the malformation, retlen
may be set to 1. To disambiguate, upon a zero return, see if the first byte of s
is 0 as well. If so, the input was a NUL
; if not, the input had an error. Or you can use "utf8n_to_uvchr_error"
.
Certain code points are considered problematic. These are Unicode surrogates, Unicode non-characters, and code points above the Unicode maximum of 0x10FFFF. By default these are considered regular code points, but certain situations warrant special handling for them, which can be specified using the flags
parameter. If flags
contains UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
, all three classes are treated as malformations and handled as such. The flags UTF8_DISALLOW_SURROGATE
, UTF8_DISALLOW_NONCHAR
, and UTF8_DISALLOW_SUPER
(meaning above the legal Unicode maximum) can be set to disallow these categories individually. UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
restricts the allowed inputs to the strict UTF-8 traditionally defined by Unicode. Use UTF8_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
to use the strictness definition given by Unicode Corrigendum #9. The difference between traditional strictness and C9 strictness is that the latter does not forbid non-character code points. (They are still discouraged, however.) For more discussion see "Noncharacter code points" in perlunicode.
The flags UTF8_WARN_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
, UTF8_WARN_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
, UTF8_WARN_SURROGATE
, UTF8_WARN_NONCHAR
, and UTF8_WARN_SUPER
will cause warning messages to be raised for their respective categories, but otherwise the code points are considered valid (not malformations). To get a category to both be treated as a malformation and raise a warning, specify both the WARN and DISALLOW flags. (But note that warnings are not raised if lexically disabled nor if UTF8_CHECK_ONLY
is also specified.)
Extremely high code points were never specified in any standard, and require an extension to UTF-8 to express, which Perl does. It is likely that programs written in something other than Perl would not be able to read files that contain these; nor would Perl understand files written by something that uses a different extension. For these reasons, there is a separate set of flags that can warn and/or disallow these extremely high code points, even if other above-Unicode ones are accepted. They are the UTF8_WARN_PERL_EXTENDED
and UTF8_DISALLOW_PERL_EXTENDED
flags. For more information see "UTF8_GOT_PERL_EXTENDED
". Of course UTF8_DISALLOW_SUPER
will treat all above-Unicode code points, including these, as malformations. (Note that the Unicode standard considers anything above 0x10FFFF to be illegal, but there are standards predating it that allow up to 0x7FFF_FFFF (2**31 -1))
A somewhat misleadingly named synonym for UTF8_WARN_PERL_EXTENDED
is retained for backward compatibility: UTF8_WARN_ABOVE_31_BIT
. Similarly, UTF8_DISALLOW_ABOVE_31_BIT
is usable instead of the more accurately named UTF8_DISALLOW_PERL_EXTENDED
. The names are misleading because these flags can apply to code points that actually do fit in 31 bits. This happens on EBCDIC platforms, and sometimes when the overlong malformation is also present. The new names accurately describe the situation in all cases.
All other code points corresponding to Unicode characters, including private use and those yet to be assigned, are never considered malformed and never warn.
UV utf8n_to_uvchr(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen,
STRLEN *retlen, const U32 flags)
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES. Most code should use "utf8_to_uvchr_buf"() rather than call this directly.
This function is for code that needs to know what the precise malformation(s) are when an error is found. If you also need to know the generated warning messages, use "utf8n_to_uvchr_msgs"() instead.
It is like "utf8n_to_uvchr"
but it takes an extra parameter placed after all the others, errors
. If this parameter is 0, this function behaves identically to "utf8n_to_uvchr"
. Otherwise, errors
should be a pointer to a U32
variable, which this function sets to indicate any errors found. Upon return, if *errors
is 0, there were no errors found. Otherwise, *errors
is the bit-wise OR
of the bits described in the list below. Some of these bits will be set if a malformation is found, even if the input flags
parameter indicates that the given malformation is allowed; those exceptions are noted:
UTF8_GOT_PERL_EXTENDED
The input sequence is not standard UTF-8, but a Perl extension. This bit is set only if the input flags
parameter contains either the UTF8_DISALLOW_PERL_EXTENDED
or the UTF8_WARN_PERL_EXTENDED
flags.
Code points above 0x7FFF_FFFF (2**31 - 1) were never specified in any standard, and so some extension must be used to express them. Perl uses a natural extension to UTF-8 to represent the ones up to 2**36-1, and invented a further extension to represent even higher ones, so that any code point that fits in a 64-bit word can be represented. Text using these extensions is not likely to be portable to non-Perl code. We lump both of these extensions together and refer to them as Perl extended UTF-8. There exist other extensions that people have invented, incompatible with Perl's.
On EBCDIC platforms starting in Perl v5.24, the Perl extension for representing extremely high code points kicks in at 0x3FFF_FFFF (2**30 -1), which is lower than on ASCII. Prior to that, code points 2**31 and higher were simply unrepresentable, and a different, incompatible method was used to represent code points between 2**30 and 2**31 - 1.
On both platforms, ASCII and EBCDIC, UTF8_GOT_PERL_EXTENDED
is set if Perl extended UTF-8 is used.
In earlier Perls, this bit was named UTF8_GOT_ABOVE_31_BIT
, which you still may use for backward compatibility. That name is misleading, as this flag may be set when the code point actually does fit in 31 bits. This happens on EBCDIC platforms, and sometimes when the overlong malformation is also present. The new name accurately describes the situation in all cases.
UTF8_GOT_CONTINUATION
The input sequence was malformed in that the first byte was a a UTF-8 continuation byte.
UTF8_GOT_EMPTY
The input curlen
parameter was 0.
UTF8_GOT_LONG
The input sequence was malformed in that there is some other sequence that evaluates to the same code point, but that sequence is shorter than this one.
Until Unicode 3.1, it was legal for programs to accept this malformation, but it was discovered that this created security issues.
UTF8_GOT_NONCHAR
The code point represented by the input UTF-8 sequence is for a Unicode non-character code point. This bit is set only if the input flags
parameter contains either the UTF8_DISALLOW_NONCHAR
or the UTF8_WARN_NONCHAR
flags.
UTF8_GOT_NON_CONTINUATION
The input sequence was malformed in that a non-continuation type byte was found in a position where only a continuation type one should be. See also "UTF8_GOT_SHORT
".
UTF8_GOT_OVERFLOW
The input sequence was malformed in that it is for a code point that is not representable in the number of bits available in an IV on the current platform.
UTF8_GOT_SHORT
The input sequence was malformed in that curlen
is smaller than required for a complete sequence. In other words, the input is for a partial character sequence.
UTF8_GOT_SHORT
and UTF8_GOT_NON_CONTINUATION
both indicate a too short sequence. The difference is that UTF8_GOT_NON_CONTINUATION
indicates always that there is an error, while UTF8_GOT_SHORT
means that an incomplete sequence was looked at. If no other flags are present, it means that the sequence was valid as far as it went. Depending on the application, this could mean one of three things:
The curlen
length parameter passed in was too small, and the function was prevented from examining all the necessary bytes.
The buffer being looked at is based on reading data, and the data received so far stopped in the middle of a character, so that the next read will read the remainder of this character. (It is up to the caller to deal with the split bytes somehow.)
This is a real error, and the partial sequence is all we're going to get.
UTF8_GOT_SUPER
The input sequence was malformed in that it is for a non-Unicode code point; that is, one above the legal Unicode maximum. This bit is set only if the input flags
parameter contains either the UTF8_DISALLOW_SUPER
or the UTF8_WARN_SUPER
flags.
UTF8_GOT_SURROGATE
The input sequence was malformed in that it is for a -Unicode UTF-16 surrogate code point. This bit is set only if the input flags
parameter contains either the UTF8_DISALLOW_SURROGATE
or the UTF8_WARN_SURROGATE
flags.
To do your own error handling, call this function with the UTF8_CHECK_ONLY
flag to suppress any warnings, and then examine the *errors
return.
UV utf8n_to_uvchr_error(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen,
STRLEN *retlen,
const U32 flags,
U32 * errors)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES. Most code should use "utf8_to_uvchr_buf"() rather than call this directly.
This function is for code that needs to know what the precise malformation(s) are when an error is found, and wants the corresponding warning and/or error messages to be returned to the caller rather than be displayed. All messages that would have been displayed if all lexcial warnings are enabled will be returned.
It is just like "utf8n_to_uvchr_error"
but it takes an extra parameter placed after all the others, msgs
. If this parameter is 0, this function behaves identically to "utf8n_to_uvchr_error"
. Otherwise, msgs
should be a pointer to an AV *
variable, in which this function creates a new AV to contain any appropriate messages. The elements of the array are ordered so that the first message that would have been displayed is in the 0th element, and so on. Each element is a hash with three key-value pairs, as follows:
text
The text of the message as a SVpv
.
warn_categories
The warning category (or categories) packed into a SVuv
.
flag
A single flag bit associated with this message, in a SVuv
. The bit corresponds to some bit in the *errors
return value, such as UTF8_GOT_LONG
.
It's important to note that specifying this parameter as non-null will cause any warnings this function would otherwise generate to be suppressed, and instead be placed in *msgs
. The caller can check the lexical warnings state (or not) when choosing what to do with the returned messages.
If the flag UTF8_CHECK_ONLY
is passed, no warnings are generated, and hence no AV is created.
The caller, of course, is responsible for freeing any returned AV.
UV utf8n_to_uvchr_msgs(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen,
STRLEN *retlen,
const U32 flags,
U32 * errors, AV ** msgs)
Instead use "utf8_to_uvchr_buf", or rarely, "utf8n_to_uvchr".
This function was useful for code that wanted to handle both EBCDIC and ASCII platforms with Unicode properties, but starting in Perl v5.20, the distinctions between the platforms have mostly been made invisible to most code, so this function is quite unlikely to be what you want. If you do need this precise functionality, use instead NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8_to_uvchr_buf(...))
or NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8n_to_uvchr(...))
.
UV utf8n_to_uvuni(const U8 *s, STRLEN curlen,
STRLEN *retlen, U32 flags)
returns the number of bytes in the UTF-8 encoded character whose first (perhaps only) byte is pointed to by s
.
STRLEN UTF8SKIP(char* s)
Returns the number of UTF-8 characters between the UTF-8 pointers a
and b
.
WARNING: use only if you *know* that the pointers point inside the same UTF-8 buffer.
IV utf8_distance(const U8 *a, const U8 *b)
Return the UTF-8 pointer s
displaced by off
characters, either forward or backward.
WARNING: do not use the following unless you *know* off
is within the UTF-8 data pointed to by s
*and* that on entry s
is aligned on the first byte of character or just after the last byte of a character.
U8* utf8_hop(const U8 *s, SSize_t off)
Return the UTF-8 pointer s
displaced by up to off
characters, backward.
off
must be non-positive.
s
must be after or equal to start
.
When moving backward it will not move before start
.
Will not exceed this limit even if the string is not valid "UTF-8".
U8* utf8_hop_back(const U8 *s, SSize_t off,
const U8 *start)
Return the UTF-8 pointer s
displaced by up to off
characters, forward.
off
must be non-negative.
s
must be before or equal to end
.
When moving forward it will not move beyond end
.
Will not exceed this limit even if the string is not valid "UTF-8".
U8* utf8_hop_forward(const U8 *s, SSize_t off,
const U8 *end)
Return the UTF-8 pointer s
displaced by up to off
characters, either forward or backward.
When moving backward it will not move before start
.
When moving forward it will not move beyond end
.
Will not exceed those limits even if the string is not valid "UTF-8".
U8* utf8_hop_safe(const U8 *s, SSize_t off,
const U8 *start, const U8 *end)
Evaluates to 1 if the byte c
represents the same character when encoded in UTF-8 as when not; otherwise evaluates to 0. UTF-8 invariant characters can be copied as-is when converting to/from UTF-8, saving time.
In spite of the name, this macro gives the correct result if the input string from which c
comes is not encoded in UTF-8.
See "UVCHR_IS_INVARIANT"
for checking if a UV is invariant.
bool UTF8_IS_INVARIANT(char c)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8 that represents one of the Unicode non-character code points; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation.
bool UTF8_IS_NONCHAR(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
Recall that Perl recognizes an extension to UTF-8 that can encode code points larger than the ones defined by Unicode, which are 0..0x10FFFF.
This macro evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are from this UTF-8 extension; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation.
0 is returned if the bytes are not well-formed extended UTF-8, or if they represent a code point that cannot fit in a UV on the current platform. Hence this macro can give different results when run on a 64-bit word machine than on one with a 32-bit word size.
Note that it is illegal to have code points that are larger than what can fit in an IV on the current machine.
bool UTF8_IS_SUPER(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
Evaluates to non-zero if the first few bytes of the string starting at s
and looking no further than e - 1
are well-formed UTF-8 that represents one of the Unicode surrogate code points; otherwise it evaluates to 0. If non-zero, the value gives how many bytes starting at s
comprise the code point's representation.
bool UTF8_IS_SURROGATE(const U8 *s, const U8 *e)
Returns the number of characters in the sequence of UTF-8-encoded bytes starting at s
and ending at the byte just before e
. If <s> and <e> point to the same place, it returns 0 with no warning raised.
If e < s
or if the scan would end up past e
, it raises a UTF8 warning and returns the number of valid characters.
STRLEN utf8_length(const U8* s, const U8 *e)
returns 0 if s >= e
; otherwise returns the number of bytes in the UTF-8 encoded character whose first byte is pointed to by s
. But it never returns beyond e
. On DEBUGGING builds, it asserts that s <= e
.
STRLEN UTF8_SAFE_SKIP(char* s, char* e)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Converts a string "s"
of length *lenp
from UTF-8 into native byte encoding. Unlike "bytes_to_utf8", this over-writes the original string, and updates *lenp
to contain the new length. Returns zero on failure (leaving "s"
unchanged) setting *lenp
to -1.
Upon successful return, the number of variants in the string can be computed by having saved the value of *lenp
before the call, and subtracting the after-call value of *lenp
from it.
If you need a copy of the string, see "bytes_from_utf8".
U8* utf8_to_bytes(U8 *s, STRLEN *lenp)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Returns the native code point of the first character in the string s
which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; retlen
will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
Some, but not all, UTF-8 malformations are detected, and in fact, some malformed input could cause reading beyond the end of the input buffer, which is why this function is deprecated. Use "utf8_to_uvchr_buf" instead.
If s
points to one of the detected malformations, and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL
) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL) so that (s
+ *retlen
) is the next possible position in s
that could begin a non-malformed character. See "utf8n_to_uvchr" for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvchr(const U8 *s, STRLEN *retlen)
Returns the native code point of the first character in the string s
which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; send
points to 1 beyond the end of s
. *retlen
will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
If s
does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL
) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value, if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER if not), is silently returned, and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL
) so that (s
+ *retlen
) is the next possible position in s
that could begin a non-malformed character. See "utf8n_to_uvchr" for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvchr_buf(const U8 *s, const U8 *send,
STRLEN *retlen)
DEPRECATED! It is planned to remove this function from a future release of Perl. Do not use it for new code; remove it from existing code.
Only in very rare circumstances should code need to be dealing in Unicode (as opposed to native) code points. In those few cases, use NATIVE_TO_UNI(utf8_to_uvchr_buf(...))
instead. If you are not absolutely sure this is one of those cases, then assume it isn't and use plain utf8_to_uvchr_buf
instead.
Returns the Unicode (not-native) code point of the first character in the string s
which is assumed to be in UTF-8 encoding; send
points to 1 beyond the end of s
. retlen
will be set to the length, in bytes, of that character.
If s
does not point to a well-formed UTF-8 character and UTF8 warnings are enabled, zero is returned and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL) to -1. If those warnings are off, the computed value if well-defined (or the Unicode REPLACEMENT CHARACTER, if not) is silently returned, and *retlen
is set (if retlen
isn't NULL) so that (s
+ *retlen
) is the next possible position in s
that could begin a non-malformed character. See "utf8n_to_uvchr" for details on when the REPLACEMENT CHARACTER is returned.
UV utf8_to_uvuni_buf(const U8 *s, const U8 *send,
STRLEN *retlen)
Evaluates to 1 if the representation of code point cp
is the same whether or not it is encoded in UTF-8; otherwise evaluates to 0. UTF-8 invariant characters can be copied as-is when converting to/from UTF-8, saving time. cp
is Unicode if above 255; otherwise is platform-native.
bool UVCHR_IS_INVARIANT(UV cp)
returns the number of bytes required to represent the code point cp
when encoded as UTF-8. cp
is a native (ASCII or EBCDIC) code point if less than 255; a Unicode code point otherwise.
STRLEN UVCHR_SKIP(UV cp)
Adds the UTF-8 representation of the native code point uv
to the end of the string d
; d
should have at least UVCHR_SKIP(uv)+1
(up to UTF8_MAXBYTES+1
) free bytes available. The return value is the pointer to the byte after the end of the new character. In other words,
d = uvchr_to_utf8(d, uv);
is the recommended wide native character-aware way of saying
*(d++) = uv;
This function accepts any code point from 0..IV_MAX
as input. IV_MAX
is typically 0x7FFF_FFFF in a 32-bit word.
It is possible to forbid or warn on non-Unicode code points, or those that may be problematic by using "uvchr_to_utf8_flags".
U8* uvchr_to_utf8(U8 *d, UV uv)
Adds the UTF-8 representation of the native code point uv
to the end of the string d
; d
should have at least UVCHR_SKIP(uv)+1
(up to UTF8_MAXBYTES+1
) free bytes available. The return value is the pointer to the byte after the end of the new character. In other words,
d = uvchr_to_utf8_flags(d, uv, flags);
or, in most cases,
d = uvchr_to_utf8_flags(d, uv, 0);
This is the Unicode-aware way of saying
*(d++) = uv;
If flags
is 0, this function accepts any code point from 0..IV_MAX
as input. IV_MAX
is typically 0x7FFF_FFFF in a 32-bit word.
Specifying flags
can further restrict what is allowed and not warned on, as follows:
If uv
is a Unicode surrogate code point and UNICODE_WARN_SURROGATE
is set, the function will raise a warning, provided UTF8 warnings are enabled. If instead UNICODE_DISALLOW_SURROGATE
is set, the function will fail and return NULL. If both flags are set, the function will both warn and return NULL.
Similarly, the UNICODE_WARN_NONCHAR
and UNICODE_DISALLOW_NONCHAR
flags affect how the function handles a Unicode non-character.
And likewise, the UNICODE_WARN_SUPER
and UNICODE_DISALLOW_SUPER
flags affect the handling of code points that are above the Unicode maximum of 0x10FFFF. Languages other than Perl may not be able to accept files that contain these.
The flag UNICODE_WARN_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
selects all three of the above WARN flags; and UNICODE_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
selects all three DISALLOW flags. UNICODE_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_INTERCHANGE
restricts the allowed inputs to the strict UTF-8 traditionally defined by Unicode. Similarly, UNICODE_WARN_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
and UNICODE_DISALLOW_ILLEGAL_C9_INTERCHANGE
are shortcuts to select the above-Unicode and surrogate flags, but not the non-character ones, as defined in Unicode Corrigendum #9. See "Noncharacter code points" in perlunicode.
Extremely high code points were never specified in any standard, and require an extension to UTF-8 to express, which Perl does. It is likely that programs written in something other than Perl would not be able to read files that contain these; nor would Perl understand files written by something that uses a different extension. For these reasons, there is a separate set of flags that can warn and/or disallow these extremely high code points, even if other above-Unicode ones are accepted. They are the UNICODE_WARN_PERL_EXTENDED
and UNICODE_DISALLOW_PERL_EXTENDED
flags. For more information see "UTF8_GOT_PERL_EXTENDED
". Of course UNICODE_DISALLOW_SUPER
will treat all above-Unicode code points, including these, as malformations. (Note that the Unicode standard considers anything above 0x10FFFF to be illegal, but there are standards predating it that allow up to 0x7FFF_FFFF (2**31 -1))
A somewhat misleadingly named synonym for UNICODE_WARN_PERL_EXTENDED
is retained for backward compatibility: UNICODE_WARN_ABOVE_31_BIT
. Similarly, UNICODE_DISALLOW_ABOVE_31_BIT
is usable instead of the more accurately named UNICODE_DISALLOW_PERL_EXTENDED
. The names are misleading because on EBCDIC platforms,these flags can apply to code points that actually do fit in 31 bits. The new names accurately describe the situation in all cases.
U8* uvchr_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES.
Most code should use "uvchr_to_utf8_flags"()
rather than call this directly.
This function is for code that wants any warning and/or error messages to be returned to the caller rather than be displayed. All messages that would have been displayed if all lexical warnings are enabled will be returned.
It is just like "uvchr_to_utf8_flags"
but it takes an extra parameter placed after all the others, msgs
. If this parameter is 0, this function behaves identically to "uvchr_to_utf8_flags"
. Otherwise, msgs
should be a pointer to an HV *
variable, in which this function creates a new HV to contain any appropriate messages. The hash has three key-value pairs, as follows:
text
The text of the message as a SVpv
.
warn_categories
The warning category (or categories) packed into a SVuv
.
flag
A single flag bit associated with this message, in a SVuv
. The bit corresponds to some bit in the *errors
return value, such as UNICODE_GOT_SURROGATE
.
It's important to note that specifying this parameter as non-null will cause any warnings this function would otherwise generate to be suppressed, and instead be placed in *msgs
. The caller can check the lexical warnings state (or not) when choosing what to do with the returned messages.
The caller, of course, is responsible for freeing any returned HV.
U8* uvchr_to_utf8_flags_msgs(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags,
HV ** msgs)
THIS FUNCTION SHOULD BE USED IN ONLY VERY SPECIALIZED CIRCUMSTANCES. Instead, Almost all code should use "uvchr_to_utf8" or "uvchr_to_utf8_flags".
This function is like them, but the input is a strict Unicode (as opposed to native) code point. Only in very rare circumstances should code not be using the native code point.
For details, see the description for "uvchr_to_utf8_flags".
U8* uvoffuni_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv,
const UV flags)
Instead you almost certainly want to use "uvchr_to_utf8" or "uvchr_to_utf8_flags".
This function is a deprecated synonym for "uvoffuni_to_utf8_flags", which itself, while not deprecated, should be used only in isolated circumstances. These functions were useful for code that wanted to handle both EBCDIC and ASCII platforms with Unicode properties, but starting in Perl v5.20, the distinctions between the platforms have mostly been made invisible to most code, so this function is quite unlikely to be what you want.
U8* uvuni_to_utf8_flags(U8 *d, UV uv, UV flags)
NOTE: this function is experimental and may change or be removed without notice.
Is the SV a valid identifier? Returns a boolean and checks for mixed unicode scripts and normalizes the string if needed. Sets normalize then.
To detect illegal but valid builtin global $main::
variables, such as <$">, you need to set allow_package and use the "main::" or "::" prefix.
normalizep must not be NULL. On strict_names it will die and not return FALSE. Similar code as in toke.c but member of the public API. But in toke.c illegal UTF-8 will error with "Unrecognized character".
${"\xc3\x28"} => FALSE. Illegal unicode, but no warning or error.
${"E\x{45}\x{301}"} => TRUE. Normalized to $E\x{c9}
${"एxṰர::ʦፖㄡsȨ"} => FALSE. Error: Invalid script Tamil in identifier
ர::ʦፖㄡsȨ for U+0BB0. Have Devanagari
Maybe if a GV or shared PV have the HEK_WASUTF8 flag set, honor that. Though this would be 128-255 chars which are all valid Latin1 identifier chars.
bool valid_ident(SV* sv, bool strict_names,
bool allow_package, int *normalizep)
Like "utf8_to_uvchr_buf"
, but should only be called when it is known that the next character in the input UTF-8 string s
is well-formed (e.g., it passes "isUTF8_CHAR"
. Surrogates, non-character code points, and non-Unicode code points are allowed.
UV valid_utf8_to_uvchr(const U8 *s, STRLEN *retlen)
xsubpp
and xsubpp
internal functionsUsed by xsubpp
to hook up XSUBs as Perl subs. Adds Perl prototypes to the subs.
Macro to verify that the perl api version an XS module has been compiled against matches the api version of the perl interpreter it's being loaded into.
XS_APIVERSION_BOOTCHECK;
The version identifier for an XS module. This is usually handled automatically by ExtUtils::MakeMaker
. See "XS_VERSION_BOOTCHECK"
.
Macro to verify that a PM module's $VERSION
variable matches the XS module's XS_VERSION
variable. This is usually handled automatically by xsubpp
. See "The VERSIONCHECK: Keyword" in perlxs.
XS_VERSION_BOOTCHECK;
Returns a new version object based on the passed in SV:
SV *sv = new_version(SV *ver);
Does not alter the passed in ver SV. See "upg_version" if you want to upgrade the SV.
SV* new_version(SV *ver)
Validate that a given string can be parsed as a version object, but doesn't actually perform the parsing. Can use either strict or lax validation rules. Can optionally set a number of hint variables to save the parsing code some time when tokenizing.
const char* prescan_version(const char *s, bool strict,
const char** errstr,
bool *sqv,
int *ssaw_decimal,
int *swidth, bool *salpha)
Returns a pointer to the next character after the parsed version string, as well as upgrading the passed in SV to an RV.
Function must be called with an already existing SV like
sv = newSV(0);
s = scan_version(s, SV *sv, bool qv);
Performs some preprocessing to the string to ensure that it has the correct characteristics of a version. Flags the object if it contains an underscore (which denotes this is an alpha version). The boolean qv denotes that the version should be interpreted as if it had multiple decimals, even if it doesn't.
const char* scan_version(const char *s, SV *rv, bool qv)
In-place upgrade of the supplied SV to a version object.
SV *sv = upg_version(SV *sv, bool qv);
Returns a pointer to the upgraded SV. Set the boolean qv if you want to force this SV to be interpreted as an "extended" version.
SV* upg_version(SV *ver, bool qv)
Version object aware cmp. Both operands must already have been converted into version objects.
int vcmp(SV *lhv, SV *rhv)
Accepts a version object and returns the normalized string representation. Call like:
sv = vnormal(rv);
NOTE: you can pass either the object directly or the SV contained within the RV.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vnormal(SV *vs)
Accepts a version object and returns the normalized floating point representation. Call like:
sv = vnumify(rv);
NOTE: you can pass either the object directly or the SV contained within the RV.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vnumify(SV *vs)
In order to maintain maximum compatibility with earlier versions of Perl, this function will return either the floating point notation or the multiple dotted notation, depending on whether the original version contained 1 or more dots, respectively.
The SV returned has a refcount of 1.
SV* vstringify(SV *vs)
Validates that the SV contains valid internal structure for a version object. It may be passed either the version object (RV) or the hash itself (HV). If the structure is valid, it returns the HV. If the structure is invalid, it returns NULL.
SV *hv = vverify(sv);
Note that it only confirms the bare minimum structure (so as not to get confused by derived classes which may contain additional hash entries):
The SV is an HV or a reference to an HV
The hash contains a "version" key
The "version" key has a reference to an AV as its value
SV* vverify(SV *vs)
Returns a boolean as to whether or not warnings are enabled for the warning category w
. If the category is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
, instead use the "ckWARN_d" macro.
bool ckWARN(U32 w)
implements the ckWARN? macros. If lexical warnings have not been set, use $^W.
bool ckwarn(U32 w)
Like "ckWARN"
, but takes two warnings categories as input, and returns TRUE if either is enabled. If either category is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
, instead use the "ckWARN2_d" macro. The categories must be completely independent, one may not be subclassed from the other.
bool ckWARN2(U32 w1, U32 w2)
Like "ckWARN2"
, but takes three warnings categories as input, and returns TRUE if any is enabled. If any of the categories is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
, instead use the "ckWARN3_d" macro. The categories must be completely independent, one may not be subclassed from any other.
bool ckWARN3(U32 w1, U32 w2, U32 w3)
Like "ckWARN3"
, but takes four warnings categories as input, and returns TRUE if any is enabled. If any of the categories is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
, instead use the "ckWARN4_d" macro. The categories must be completely independent, one may not be subclassed from any other.
bool ckWARN4(U32 w1, U32 w2, U32 w3, U32 w4)
Like "ckWARN"
, but for use if and only if the warning category is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
.
bool ckWARN_d(U32 w)
implements the ckWARN?_d macro. If lexical warnings have not been set then default classes warn.
bool ckwarn_d(U32 w)
If lexical warnings have not been set, use $^W
.
void ck_warner(U32 err, const char* pat, ...)
If lexical warnings have not been set then default classes warn.
void ck_warner_d(U32 err, const char* pat, ...)
Like "ckWARN2"
, but for use if and only if either warning category is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
.
bool ckWARN2_d(U32 w1, U32 w2)
Like "ckWARN3"
, but for use if and only if any of the warning categories is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
.
bool ckWARN3_d(U32 w1, U32 w2, U32 w3)
Like "ckWARN4"
, but for use if and only if any of the warning categories is by default enabled even if not within the scope of use warnings
.
bool ckWARN4_d(U32 w1, U32 w2, U32 w3, U32 w4)
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" in perlfunc function.
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing eval
, but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__}
handler. In any case, the croak
function never returns normally.
For historical reasons, if pat
is null then the contents of ERRSV
($@
) will be used as an error message or object instead of building an error message from arguments. If you want to throw a non-string object, or build an error message in an SV yourself, it is preferable to use the "croak_sv" function, which does not involve clobbering ERRSV
.
void croak(const char *pat, ...)
Almost equivalent to Perl_croak(aTHX_ "%s", PL_no_modify)
, but with better DEBUGGING diagnostics.
void croak_no_modify()
Same as "croak_no_modify", just with better debugging code.
void croak_no_modify_sv()
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" in perlfunc function.
baseex
is the error message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it does not end with a newline then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message or object will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing eval
, but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__}
handler. In any case, the croak_sv
function never returns normally.
To die with a simple string message, the "croak" function may be more convenient.
void croak_sv(SV *baseex)
Behaves the same as "croak", except for the return type. It should be used only where the OP *
return type is required. The function never actually returns.
OP * die(const char *pat, ...)
Behaves the same as "croak_sv", except for the return type. It should be used only where the OP *
return type is required. The function never actually returns.
OP * die_sv(SV *baseex)
Fills the buffer to
with len
characters of from
, count
times.
Errors with a negative len
argument. There's no check for a maximal overall length written into the to
buffer, the resulting length is not returned, it must be precalculated in the caller.
Note that perl5 and older perls have the count
argument as IV, so a count value gt
IV_MAX might do different things. Before, negative count
arguments failed with croak_memory_wrap
, now they are casted to UV and performed.
void repeatcpy(char* to, const char* from, I32 len,
UV count)
This is an XS interface to Perl's "die" in perlfunc function.
pat
and args
are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message will be used as an exception, by default returning control to the nearest enclosing eval
, but subject to modification by a $SIG{__DIE__}
handler. In any case, the "croak" function never returns normally.
For historical reasons, if pat
is null then the contents of ERRSV
($@
) will be used as an error message or object instead of building an error message from arguments. If you want to throw a non-string object, or build an error message in an SV yourself, it is preferable to use the "croak_sv" function, which does not involve clobbering ERRSV
.
void vcroak(const char *pat, va_list *args)
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" in perlfunc function.
pat
and args
are a sprintf-style format pattern and encapsulated argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__}
handler.
Unlike with "vcroak", pat
is not permitted to be null.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void vwarn(const char* pat, va_list* args)
The warner variant without varargs, thus suitable for a non-C99 macro. "warner" uses this.
void vwarner(U32 err, const char* pat, va_list* args)
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" in perlfunc function.
Take a sprintf-style format pattern and argument list. These are used to generate a string message. If the message does not end with a newline, then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__}
handler.
Unlike with "croak", pat
is not permitted to be null.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void warn(const char* pat, ...)
"warn" without checking the state of lexical warnings or global $^W
.
void warner(U32 err, const char* pat, ...)
This does an extended "warn" call, dependent on the lexical state of warnings 'security', which is on by default.
It prefixes the warning with "SECURITY:" and suffixes it with information of the caller. The full path of the application, if $ENV{REMOTE_ADDR}
prints the ip and user name, if local the user name.
If syslog is supported also prints to the syslog. (TODO)
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void warn_security(const char* pat, ...)
This is an XS interface to Perl's "warn" in perlfunc function.
baseex
is the error message or object. If it is a reference, it will be used as-is. Otherwise it is used as a string, and if it does not end with a newline then it will be extended with some indication of the current location in the code, as described for "mess_sv".
The error message or object will by default be written to standard error, but this is subject to modification by a $SIG{__WARN__}
handler.
To warn with a simple string message, the "warn" function may be more convenient.
NOTE: the perl_ form of this function is deprecated.
void warn_sv(SV *baseex)
The following functions have been flagged as part of the public API, but are currently undocumented. Use them at your own risk, as the interfaces are subject to change. Functions that are not listed in this document are not intended for public use, and should NOT be used under any circumstances.
If you feel you need to use one of these functions, first send email to perl5-porters@perl.org. It may be that there is a good reason for the function not being documented, and it should be removed from this list; or it may just be that no one has gotten around to documenting it. In the latter case, you will be asked to submit a patch to document the function. Once your patch is accepted, it will indicate that the interface is stable (unless it is explicitly marked otherwise) and usable by you.
Until May 1997, this document was maintained by Jeff Okamoto <okamoto@corp.hp.com>. It is now maintained as part of Perl itself.
With lots of help and suggestions from Dean Roehrich, Malcolm Beattie, Andreas Koenig, Paul Hudson, Ilya Zakharevich, Paul Marquess, Neil Bowers, Matthew Green, Tim Bunce, Spider Boardman, Ulrich Pfeifer, Stephen McCamant, and Gurusamy Sarathy.
API Listing originally by Dean Roehrich <roehrich@cray.com>.
Updated to be autogenerated from comments in the source by Benjamin Stuhl.